/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit * Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald * * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either * version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. * * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU * Lesser General Public License for more details. * * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public * License along with this library. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ /* * Modified by the GTK+ Team and others 1997-2000. See the AUTHORS * file for a list of people on the GTK+ Team. See the ChangeLog * files for a list of changes. These files are distributed with * GTK+ at ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/. */ #include "config.h" #include <stdarg.h> #include <string.h> #include <locale.h> #include <math.h> #define GDK_COMPILATION #include "gdk/gdkeventsprivate.h" #include <gobject/gvaluecollector.h> #include <gobject/gobjectnotifyqueue.c> #include <cairo-gobject.h> #include "gtkcontainer.h" #include "gtkaccelmapprivate.h" #include "gtkaccelgroupprivate.h" #include "gtkcssfiltervalueprivate.h" #include "gtkcssnumbervalueprivate.h" #include "gtkcssshadowsvalueprivate.h" #include "gtkcssstylepropertyprivate.h" #include "gtkintl.h" #include "gtkmarshalers.h" #include "gtkselectionprivate.h" #include "gtksettingsprivate.h" #include "gtksizegroup-private.h" #include "gtkwidget.h" #include "gtkwidgetprivate.h" #include "gtkwindowprivate.h" #include "gtkcontainerprivate.h" #include "gtkbindings.h" #include "gtkprivate.h" #include "gtkaccessible.h" #include "gtktooltipprivate.h" #include "gtkinvisible.h" #include "gtkbuildable.h" #include "gtkbuilderprivate.h" #include "gtksizerequest.h" #include "gtkstylecontextprivate.h" #include "gtkcssprovider.h" #include "gtkcsswidgetnodeprivate.h" #include "gtkversion.h" #include "gtkdebug.h" #include "gtktypebuiltins.h" #include "a11y/gtkwidgetaccessible.h" #include "gtkapplicationprivate.h" #include "gtkgestureprivate.h" #include "gtkwidgetpathprivate.h" #include "gtksnapshotprivate.h" #include "gtkrenderborderprivate.h" #include "gtkrenderbackgroundprivate.h" #include "gtkcssshadowsvalueprivate.h" #include "gtkdebugupdatesprivate.h" #include "gsk/gskdebugprivate.h" #include "gtkeventcontrollerlegacyprivate.h" #include "inspector/window.h" /* for the use of round() */ #include "fallback-c89.c" /** * SECTION:gtkwidget * @Short_description: Base class for all widgets * @Title: GtkWidget * * GtkWidget is the base class all widgets in GTK+ derive from. It manages the * widget lifecycle, states and style. * * # Height-for-width Geometry Management # {#geometry-management} * * GTK+ uses a height-for-width (and width-for-height) geometry management * system. Height-for-width means that a widget can change how much * vertical space it needs, depending on the amount of horizontal space * that it is given (and similar for width-for-height). The most common * example is a label that reflows to fill up the available width, wraps * to fewer lines, and therefore needs less height. * * Height-for-width geometry management is implemented in GTK+ by way * of two virtual methods: * * - #GtkWidgetClass.get_request_mode() * - #GtkWidgetClass.measure() * * There are some important things to keep in mind when implementing * height-for-width and when using it in container implementations. * * The geometry management system will query a widget hierarchy in * only one orientation at a time. When widgets are initially queried * for their minimum sizes it is generally done in two initial passes * in the #GtkSizeRequestMode chosen by the toplevel. * * For example, when queried in the normal * %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH mode: * First, the default minimum and natural width for each widget * in the interface will be computed using gtk_widget_measure() with an orientation * or %GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL and a for_size of -1. * Because the preferred widths for each container depend on the preferred * widths of their children, this information propagates up the hierarchy, * and finally a minimum and natural width is determined for the entire * toplevel. Next, the toplevel will use the minimum width to query for the * minimum height contextual to that width using gtk_widget_measure() with an * orientation of %GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL and a for_size of the just computed * width. This will also be a highly recursive operation. * The minimum height for the minimum width is normally * used to set the minimum size constraint on the toplevel * (unless gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() is explicitly used instead). * * After the toplevel window has initially requested its size in both * dimensions it can go on to allocate itself a reasonable size (or a size * previously specified with gtk_window_set_default_size()). During the * recursive allocation process it’s important to note that request cycles * will be recursively executed while container widgets allocate their children. * Each container widget, once allocated a size, will go on to first share the * space in one orientation among its children and then request each child's * height for its target allocated width or its width for allocated height, * depending. In this way a #GtkWidget will typically be requested its size * a number of times before actually being allocated a size. The size a * widget is finally allocated can of course differ from the size it has * requested. For this reason, #GtkWidget caches a small number of results * to avoid re-querying for the same sizes in one allocation cycle. * * See * [GtkContainer’s geometry management section][container-geometry-management] * to learn more about how height-for-width allocations are performed * by container widgets. * * If a widget does move content around to intelligently use up the * allocated size then it must support the request in both * #GtkSizeRequestModes even if the widget in question only * trades sizes in a single orientation. * * For instance, a #GtkLabel that does height-for-width word wrapping * will not expect to have #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() called * because that call is specific to a width-for-height request. In this * case the label must return the height required for its own minimum * possible width. By following this rule any widget that handles * height-for-width or width-for-height requests will always be allocated * at least enough space to fit its own content. * * Here are some examples of how a %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH widget * generally deals with width-for-height requests, for #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() * it will do: * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * static void * foo_widget_get_preferred_height (GtkWidget *widget, * gint *min_height, * gint *nat_height) * { * if (i_am_in_height_for_width_mode) * { * gint min_width, nat_width; * * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, * &min_width, * &nat_width); * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_height_for_width * (widget, * min_width, * min_height, * nat_height); * } * else * { * ... some widgets do both. For instance, if a GtkLabel is * rotated to 90 degrees it will return the minimum and * natural height for the rotated label here. * } * } * ]| * * And in #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width_for_height() it will simply return * the minimum and natural width: * |[<!-- language="C" --> * static void * foo_widget_get_preferred_width_for_height (GtkWidget *widget, * gint for_height, * gint *min_width, * gint *nat_width) * { * if (i_am_in_height_for_width_mode) * { * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, * min_width, * nat_width); * } * else * { * ... again if a widget is sometimes operating in * width-for-height mode (like a rotated GtkLabel) it can go * ahead and do its real width for height calculation here. * } * } * ]| * * Often a widget needs to get its own request during size request or * allocation. For example, when computing height it may need to also * compute width. Or when deciding how to use an allocation, the widget * may need to know its natural size. In these cases, the widget should * be careful to call its virtual methods directly, like this: * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS(widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, * &min, * &natural); * ]| * * It will not work to use the wrapper functions, such as * gtk_widget_get_preferred_width() inside your own size request * implementation. These return a request adjusted by #GtkSizeGroup * and by the #GtkWidgetClass.adjust_size_request() virtual method. If a * widget used the wrappers inside its virtual method implementations, * then the adjustments (such as widget margins) would be applied * twice. GTK+ therefore does not allow this and will warn if you try * to do it. * * Of course if you are getting the size request for * another widget, such as a child of a * container, you must use the wrapper APIs. * Otherwise, you would not properly consider widget margins, * #GtkSizeGroup, and so forth. * * Since 3.10 GTK+ also supports baseline vertical alignment of widgets. This * means that widgets are positioned such that the typographical baseline of * widgets in the same row are aligned. This happens if a widget supports baselines, * has a vertical alignment of %GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE, and is inside a container * that supports baselines and has a natural “row” that it aligns to the baseline, * or a baseline assigned to it by the grandparent. * * Baseline alignment support for a widget is done by the #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height_and_baseline_for_width() * virtual function. It allows you to report a baseline in combination with the * minimum and natural height. If there is no baseline you can return -1 to indicate * this. The default implementation of this virtual function calls into the * #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() and #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height_for_width(), * so if baselines are not supported it doesn’t need to be implemented. * * If a widget ends up baseline aligned it will be allocated all the space in the parent * as if it was %GTK_ALIGN_FILL, but the selected baseline can be found via gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline(). * If this has a value other than -1 you need to align the widget such that the baseline * appears at the position. * * # GtkWidget as GtkBuildable * * The GtkWidget implementation of the GtkBuildable interface supports a * custom <accelerator> element, which has attributes named ”key”, ”modifiers” * and ”signal” and allows to specify accelerators. * * An example of a UI definition fragment specifying an accelerator: * |[ * <object class="GtkButton"> * <accelerator key="q" modifiers="GDK_CONTROL_MASK" signal="clicked"/> * </object> * ]| * * In addition to accelerators, GtkWidget also support a custom <accessible> * element, which supports actions and relations. Properties on the accessible * implementation of an object can be set by accessing the internal child * “accessible” of a #GtkWidget. * * An example of a UI definition fragment specifying an accessible: * |[ * <object class="GtkButton" id="label1"/> * <property name="label">I am a Label for a Button</property> * </object> * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1"> * <accessibility> * <action action_name="click" translatable="yes">Click the button.</action> * <relation target="label1" type="labelled-by"/> * </accessibility> * <child internal-child="accessible"> * <object class="AtkObject" id="a11y-button1"> * <property name="accessible-name">Clickable Button</property> * </object> * </child> * </object> * ]| * * Finally, GtkWidget allows style information such as style classes to * be associated with widgets, using the custom <style> element: * |[ * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1"> * <style> * <class name="my-special-button-class"/> * <class name="dark-button"/> * </style> * </object> * ]| * * # Building composite widgets from template XML ## {#composite-templates} * * GtkWidget exposes some facilities to automate the procedure * of creating composite widgets using #GtkBuilder interface description * language. * * To create composite widgets with #GtkBuilder XML, one must associate * the interface description with the widget class at class initialization * time using gtk_widget_class_set_template(). * * The interface description semantics expected in composite template descriptions * is slightly different from regular #GtkBuilder XML. * * Unlike regular interface descriptions, gtk_widget_class_set_template() will * expect a <template> tag as a direct child of the toplevel <interface> * tag. The <template> tag must specify the “class” attribute which must be * the type name of the widget. Optionally, the “parent” attribute may be * specified to specify the direct parent type of the widget type, this is * ignored by the GtkBuilder but required for Glade to introspect what kind * of properties and internal children exist for a given type when the actual * type does not exist. * * The XML which is contained inside the <template> tag behaves as if it were * added to the <object> tag defining @widget itself. You may set properties * on @widget by inserting <property> tags into the <template> tag, and also * add <child> tags to add children and extend @widget in the normal way you * would with <object> tags. * * Additionally, <object> tags can also be added before and after the initial * <template> tag in the normal way, allowing one to define auxiliary objects * which might be referenced by other widgets declared as children of the * <template> tag. * * An example of a GtkBuilder Template Definition: * |[ * <interface> * <template class="FooWidget" parent="GtkBox"> * <property name="orientation">GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL</property> * <property name="spacing">4</property> * <child> * <object class="GtkButton" id="hello_button"> * <property name="label">Hello World</property> * <signal name="clicked" handler="hello_button_clicked" object="FooWidget" swapped="yes"/> * </object> * </child> * <child> * <object class="GtkButton" id="goodbye_button"> * <property name="label">Goodbye World</property> * </object> * </child> * </template> * </interface> * ]| * * Typically, you'll place the template fragment into a file that is * bundled with your project, using #GResource. In order to load the * template, you need to call gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource() * from the class initialization of your #GtkWidget type: * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * static void * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) * { * // ... * * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); * } * ]| * * You will also need to call gtk_widget_init_template() from the instance * initialization function: * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * static void * foo_widget_init (FooWidget *self) * { * // ... * gtk_widget_init_template (GTK_WIDGET (self)); * } * ]| * * You can access widgets defined in the template using the * gtk_widget_get_template_child() function, but you will typically declare * a pointer in the instance private data structure of your type using the same * name as the widget in the template definition, and call * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private() with that name, e.g. * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * typedef struct { * GtkWidget *hello_button; * GtkWidget *goodbye_button; * } FooWidgetPrivate; * * G_DEFINE_TYPE_WITH_PRIVATE (FooWidget, foo_widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX) * * static void * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) * { * // ... * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), * FooWidget, hello_button); * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), * FooWidget, goodbye_button); * } * ]| * * You can also use gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback() to connect a signal * callback defined in the template with a function visible in the scope of the * class, e.g. * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * // the signal handler has the instance and user data swapped * // because of the swapped="yes" attribute in the template XML * static void * hello_button_clicked (FooWidget *self, * GtkButton *button) * { * g_print ("Hello, world!\n"); * } * * static void * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) * { * // ... * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), hello_button_clicked); * } * ]| */ #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE (GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE|GTK_STATE_FLAG_BACKDROP) #define WIDGET_CLASS(w) GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (w) typedef struct { gchar *name; /* Name of the template automatic child */ gboolean internal_child; /* Whether the automatic widget should be exported as an <internal-child> */ gssize offset; /* Instance private data offset where to set the automatic child (or 0) */ } AutomaticChildClass; typedef struct { gchar *callback_name; GCallback callback_symbol; } CallbackSymbol; typedef struct { GBytes *data; GSList *children; GSList *callbacks; GtkBuilderConnectFunc connect_func; gpointer connect_data; GDestroyNotify destroy_notify; } GtkWidgetTemplate; typedef struct { GtkEventController *controller; guint grab_notify_id; guint sequence_state_changed_id; } EventControllerData; struct _GtkWidgetClassPrivate { GtkWidgetTemplate *template; GType accessible_type; AtkRole accessible_role; const char *css_name; }; enum { DESTROY, SHOW, HIDE, MAP, UNMAP, REALIZE, UNREALIZE, SIZE_ALLOCATE, STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED, HIERARCHY_CHANGED, DIRECTION_CHANGED, GRAB_NOTIFY, CHILD_NOTIFY, DRAW, MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE, GRAB_FOCUS, FOCUS, MOVE_FOCUS, KEYNAV_FAILED, EVENT, EVENT_AFTER, BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT, BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT, SCROLL_EVENT, MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT, DELETE_EVENT, DESTROY_EVENT, KEY_PRESS_EVENT, KEY_RELEASE_EVENT, ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT, LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT, CONFIGURE_EVENT, FOCUS_IN_EVENT, FOCUS_OUT_EVENT, MAP_EVENT, UNMAP_EVENT, PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT, SELECTION_GET, SELECTION_RECEIVED, PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT, PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT, WINDOW_STATE_EVENT, GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT, DRAG_BEGIN, DRAG_END, DRAG_DATA_DELETE, DRAG_LEAVE, DRAG_MOTION, DRAG_DROP, DRAG_DATA_GET, DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED, POPUP_MENU, ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED, DISPLAY_CHANGED, CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL, QUERY_TOOLTIP, DRAG_FAILED, STYLE_UPDATED, TOUCH_EVENT, LAST_SIGNAL }; enum { PROP_0, PROP_NAME, PROP_PARENT, PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST, PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST, PROP_VISIBLE, PROP_SENSITIVE, PROP_CAN_FOCUS, PROP_HAS_FOCUS, PROP_IS_FOCUS, PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK, PROP_CAN_DEFAULT, PROP_HAS_DEFAULT, PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT, PROP_CURSOR, PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP, PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP, PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT, PROP_WINDOW, PROP_OPACITY, PROP_HALIGN, PROP_VALIGN, PROP_MARGIN_START, PROP_MARGIN_END, PROP_MARGIN_TOP, PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM, PROP_MARGIN, PROP_HEXPAND, PROP_VEXPAND, PROP_HEXPAND_SET, PROP_VEXPAND_SET, PROP_EXPAND, PROP_SCALE_FACTOR, PROP_CSS_NAME, NUM_PROPERTIES }; static GParamSpec *widget_props[NUM_PROPERTIES] = { NULL, }; typedef struct _GtkStateData GtkStateData; struct _GtkStateData { guint flags_to_set; guint flags_to_unset; gint old_scale_factor; }; /* --- prototypes --- */ static void gtk_widget_base_class_init (gpointer g_class); static void gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass); static void gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass); static void gtk_widget_init (GTypeInstance *instance, gpointer g_class); static void gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, const GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec); static void gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec); static void gtk_widget_constructed (GObject *object); static void gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object); static void gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object); static void gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object); static void gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *allocation, int baseline, GtkAllocation *out_clip); static void gtk_widget_real_direction_changed(GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection previous_direction); static void gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gboolean keyboard_tip, GtkTooltip *tooltip); static void gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget); static gboolean _gtk_widget_run_controllers (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event, GtkPropagationPhase phase); static void gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed (GtkWidget *object, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_button_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_motion_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_press_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_release_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_touch_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventTouch *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_grab_broken_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventGrabBroken *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); static void gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS static void gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); #else #define gtk_widget_verify_invariants(widget) #define gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants(widget) #define gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants(widget) #endif static PangoContext* gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkStateData *data); static void gtk_widget_update_alpha (GtkWidget *widget); static gint gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling); static void gtk_widget_real_measure (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, int for_size, int *minimum, int *natural, int *minimum_baseline, int *natural_baseline); static void gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags old_state); static AtkObject* gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface); static AtkObject* gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id); static void gtk_widget_get_origin_relative_to_parent(GtkWidget *widget, int *origin_x, int *origin_y); static void gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip, gboolean force); static void gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface); static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, const gchar *name); static const gchar * gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable); static GObject * gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *childname); static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *name, const GValue *value); static gboolean gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, GMarkupParser *parser, gpointer *data); static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, gpointer data); static void gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder); static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_adjust_baseline_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, gint *baseline); static void template_data_free (GtkWidgetTemplate*template_data); static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height); static void gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update (GdkFrameClock *frame_clock, GtkWidget *widget); static gboolean event_window_is_still_viewable (const GdkEvent *event); static void gtk_widget_update_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget); static gboolean gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class); static void gtk_widget_set_clip (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *clip); /* --- variables --- */ static gint GtkWidget_private_offset = 0; static gpointer gtk_widget_parent_class = NULL; static guint widget_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 }; GtkTextDirection gtk_default_direction = GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR; static GQuark quark_accel_path = 0; static GQuark quark_accel_closures = 0; static GQuark quark_parent_window = 0; static GQuark quark_shape_info = 0; static GQuark quark_input_shape_info = 0; static GQuark quark_pango_context = 0; static GQuark quark_mnemonic_labels = 0; static GQuark quark_tooltip_markup = 0; static GQuark quark_tooltip_window = 0; static GQuark quark_size_groups = 0; static GQuark quark_auto_children = 0; static GQuark quark_widget_path = 0; static GQuark quark_action_muxer = 0; static GQuark quark_font_options = 0; static GQuark quark_font_map = 0; GParamSpecPool *_gtk_widget_child_property_pool = NULL; GObjectNotifyContext *_gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = NULL; /* --- functions --- */ GType gtk_widget_get_type (void) { static GType widget_type = 0; if (G_UNLIKELY (widget_type == 0)) { const GTypeInfo widget_info = { sizeof (GtkWidgetClass), gtk_widget_base_class_init, (GBaseFinalizeFunc) gtk_widget_base_class_finalize, (GClassInitFunc) gtk_widget_class_init, NULL, /* class_finalize */ NULL, /* class_init */ sizeof (GtkWidget), 0, /* n_preallocs */ gtk_widget_init, NULL, /* value_table */ }; const GInterfaceInfo accessibility_info = { (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init, (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, NULL /* interface data */ }; const GInterfaceInfo buildable_info = { (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init, (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, NULL /* interface data */ }; widget_type = g_type_register_static (G_TYPE_INITIALLY_UNOWNED, g_intern_static_string ("GtkWidget"), &widget_info, G_TYPE_FLAG_ABSTRACT); g_type_add_class_private (widget_type, sizeof (GtkWidgetClassPrivate)); GtkWidget_private_offset = g_type_add_instance_private (widget_type, sizeof (GtkWidgetPrivate)); g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, ATK_TYPE_IMPLEMENTOR, &accessibility_info) ; g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, GTK_TYPE_BUILDABLE, &buildable_info) ; } return widget_type; } static inline gpointer gtk_widget_get_instance_private (GtkWidget *self) { return (G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (self, GtkWidget_private_offset)); } static void gtk_widget_base_class_init (gpointer g_class) { GtkWidgetClass *klass = g_class; klass->priv = G_TYPE_CLASS_GET_PRIVATE (g_class, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, GtkWidgetClassPrivate); klass->priv->template = NULL; } static void child_property_notify_dispatcher (GObject *object, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs) { GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (object)->dispatch_child_properties_changed (GTK_WIDGET (object), n_pspecs, pspecs); } /* We guard against the draw signal callbacks modifying the state of the * cairo context by surrounding it with save/restore. * Maybe we should also cairo_new_path() just to be sure? */ static void gtk_widget_draw_marshaller (GClosure *closure, GValue *return_value, guint n_param_values, const GValue *param_values, gpointer invocation_hint, gpointer marshal_data) { cairo_t *cr = g_value_get_boxed (¶m_values[1]); cairo_save (cr); _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED (closure, return_value, n_param_values, param_values, invocation_hint, marshal_data); cairo_restore (cr); } static void gtk_widget_draw_marshallerv (GClosure *closure, GValue *return_value, gpointer instance, va_list args, gpointer marshal_data, int n_params, GType *param_types) { cairo_t *cr; va_list args_copy; G_VA_COPY (args_copy, args); cr = va_arg (args_copy, gpointer); cairo_save (cr); _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXEDv (closure, return_value, instance, args, marshal_data, n_params, param_types); cairo_restore (cr); va_end (args_copy); } static void gtk_widget_real_snapshot (GtkWidget *widget, GtkSnapshot *snapshot) { GtkWidget *child; for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) gtk_widget_snapshot_child (widget, child, snapshot); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_contains (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble x, gdouble y) { GtkAllocation own_alloc; gtk_widget_get_own_allocation (widget, &own_alloc); /* XXX: This misses rounded rects */ return gdk_rectangle_contains_point (&own_alloc, x, y); } static GtkWidget * gtk_widget_real_pick (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble x, gdouble y) { GtkWidget *child; for (child = _gtk_widget_get_last_child (widget); child; child = _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (child)) { GtkWidget *picked; int dx, dy; gtk_widget_get_origin_relative_to_parent (child, &dx, &dy); picked = gtk_widget_pick (child, x - dx, y - dy); if (picked) return picked; } if (!gtk_widget_contains (widget, x, y)) return NULL; return widget; } static void gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass) { static GObjectNotifyContext cpn_context = { 0, NULL, NULL }; GObjectClass *gobject_class = G_OBJECT_CLASS (klass); GtkBindingSet *binding_set; g_type_class_adjust_private_offset (klass, &GtkWidget_private_offset); gtk_widget_parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass); quark_accel_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-path"); quark_accel_closures = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-closures"); quark_parent_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-parent-window"); quark_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-shape-info"); quark_input_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-input-shape-info"); quark_pango_context = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pango-context"); quark_mnemonic_labels = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-mnemonic-labels"); quark_tooltip_markup = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-markup"); quark_tooltip_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-window"); quark_size_groups = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-size-groups"); quark_auto_children = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-auto-children"); quark_widget_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-path"); quark_action_muxer = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-action-muxer"); quark_font_options = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-font-options"); quark_font_map = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-font-map"); _gtk_widget_child_property_pool = g_param_spec_pool_new (TRUE); cpn_context.quark_notify_queue = g_quark_from_static_string ("GtkWidget-child-property-notify-queue"); cpn_context.dispatcher = child_property_notify_dispatcher; _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = &cpn_context; gobject_class->constructed = gtk_widget_constructed; gobject_class->dispose = gtk_widget_dispose; gobject_class->finalize = gtk_widget_finalize; gobject_class->set_property = gtk_widget_set_property; gobject_class->get_property = gtk_widget_get_property; klass->destroy = gtk_widget_real_destroy; klass->activate_signal = 0; klass->dispatch_child_properties_changed = gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed; klass->show = gtk_widget_real_show; klass->hide = gtk_widget_real_hide; klass->map = gtk_widget_real_map; klass->unmap = gtk_widget_real_unmap; klass->realize = gtk_widget_real_realize; klass->unrealize = gtk_widget_real_unrealize; klass->size_allocate = gtk_widget_real_size_allocate; klass->get_request_mode = gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode; klass->measure = gtk_widget_real_measure; klass->state_flags_changed = gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed; klass->hierarchy_changed = NULL; klass->direction_changed = gtk_widget_real_direction_changed; klass->grab_notify = NULL; klass->child_notify = NULL; klass->draw = NULL; klass->snapshot = gtk_widget_real_snapshot; klass->mnemonic_activate = gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate; klass->grab_focus = gtk_widget_real_grab_focus; klass->focus = gtk_widget_real_focus; klass->move_focus = gtk_widget_real_move_focus; klass->keynav_failed = gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed; klass->event = NULL; klass->button_press_event = gtk_widget_real_button_event; klass->button_release_event = gtk_widget_real_button_event; klass->motion_notify_event = gtk_widget_real_motion_event; klass->touch_event = gtk_widget_real_touch_event; klass->delete_event = NULL; klass->destroy_event = NULL; klass->key_press_event = gtk_widget_real_key_press_event; klass->key_release_event = gtk_widget_real_key_release_event; klass->enter_notify_event = NULL; klass->leave_notify_event = NULL; klass->configure_event = NULL; klass->focus_in_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event; klass->focus_out_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event; klass->map_event = NULL; klass->unmap_event = NULL; klass->window_state_event = NULL; klass->property_notify_event = NULL; klass->selection_received = NULL; klass->proximity_in_event = NULL; klass->proximity_out_event = NULL; klass->drag_begin = NULL; klass->drag_end = NULL; klass->drag_data_delete = NULL; klass->drag_leave = NULL; klass->drag_motion = NULL; klass->drag_drop = NULL; klass->drag_data_received = NULL; klass->display_changed = NULL; klass->can_activate_accel = gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel; klass->grab_broken_event = gtk_widget_real_grab_broken_event; klass->query_tooltip = gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip; klass->style_updated = gtk_widget_real_style_updated; /* Accessibility support */ klass->priv->accessible_type = GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE; klass->priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID; klass->get_accessible = gtk_widget_real_get_accessible; klass->contains = gtk_widget_real_contains; klass->pick = gtk_widget_real_pick; widget_props[PROP_NAME] = g_param_spec_string ("name", P_("Widget name"), P_("The name of the widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); widget_props[PROP_PARENT] = g_param_spec_object ("parent", P_("Parent widget"), P_("The parent widget of this widget."), GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, GTK_PARAM_READABLE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST] = g_param_spec_int ("width-request", P_("Width request"), P_("Override for width request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), -1, G_MAXINT, -1, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST] = g_param_spec_int ("height-request", P_("Height request"), P_("Override for height request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), -1, G_MAXINT, -1, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE] = g_param_spec_boolean ("visible", P_("Visible"), P_("Whether the widget is visible"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_SENSITIVE] = g_param_spec_boolean ("sensitive", P_("Sensitive"), P_("Whether the widget responds to input"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_CAN_FOCUS] = g_param_spec_boolean ("can-focus", P_("Can focus"), P_("Whether the widget can accept the input focus"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_HAS_FOCUS] = g_param_spec_boolean ("has-focus", P_("Has focus"), P_("Whether the widget has the input focus"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_IS_FOCUS] = g_param_spec_boolean ("is-focus", P_("Is focus"), P_("Whether the widget is the focus widget within the toplevel"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); /** * GtkWidget:focus-on-click: * * Whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. * * This property is only relevant for widgets that can take focus. * * Before 3.20, several widgets (GtkButton, GtkFileChooserButton, * GtkComboBox) implemented this property individually. * * Since: 3.20 */ widget_props[PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK] = g_param_spec_boolean ("focus-on-click", P_("Focus on click"), P_("Whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_CAN_DEFAULT] = g_param_spec_boolean ("can-default", P_("Can default"), P_("Whether the widget can be the default widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_HAS_DEFAULT] = g_param_spec_boolean ("has-default", P_("Has default"), P_("Whether the widget is the default widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); widget_props[PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT] = g_param_spec_boolean ("receives-default", P_("Receives default"), P_("If TRUE, the widget will receive the default action when it is focused"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:cursor: * * The cursor used by @widget. See gtk_widget_set_cursor() for details. * * Since: 3.94 */ widget_props[PROP_CURSOR] = g_param_spec_object("cursor", P_("Cursor"), P_("The cursor to show when hoving above widget"), GDK_TYPE_CURSOR, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:has-tooltip: * * Enables or disables the emission of #GtkWidget::query-tooltip on @widget. * A value of %TRUE indicates that @widget can have a tooltip, in this case * the widget will be queried using #GtkWidget::query-tooltip to determine * whether it will provide a tooltip or not. * * Note that setting this property to %TRUE for the first time will change * the event masks of the GdkWindows of this widget to include leave-notify * and motion-notify events. This cannot and will not be undone when the * property is set to %FALSE again. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_props[PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP] = g_param_spec_boolean ("has-tooltip", P_("Has tooltip"), P_("Whether this widget has a tooltip"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:tooltip-text: * * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string. * * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_text(). * * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. * * Note that if both #GtkWidget:tooltip-text and #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup * are set, the last one wins. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_props[PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT] = g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-text", P_("Tooltip Text"), P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); /** * GtkWidget:tooltip-markup: * * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string, which is marked up * with the [Pango text markup language][PangoMarkupFormat]. * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). * * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. * * Note that if both #GtkWidget:tooltip-text and #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup * are set, the last one wins. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_props[PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP] = g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-markup", P_("Tooltip markup"), P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); /** * GtkWidget:window: * * The widget's window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise. * * Since: 2.14 */ widget_props[PROP_WINDOW] = g_param_spec_object ("window", P_("Window"), P_("The widget’s window if it is realized"), GDK_TYPE_WINDOW, GTK_PARAM_READABLE); /** * GtkWidget:halign: * * How to distribute horizontal space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_HALIGN] = g_param_spec_enum ("halign", P_("Horizontal Alignment"), P_("How to position in extra horizontal space"), GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:valign: * * How to distribute vertical space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_VALIGN] = g_param_spec_enum ("valign", P_("Vertical Alignment"), P_("How to position in extra vertical space"), GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:margin-start: * * Margin on start of widget, horizontally. This property supports * left-to-right and right-to-left text directions. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.12 */ widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_START] = g_param_spec_int ("margin-start", P_("Margin on Start"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the start"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:margin-end: * * Margin on end of widget, horizontally. This property supports * left-to-right and right-to-left text directions. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.12 */ widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_END] = g_param_spec_int ("margin-end", P_("Margin on End"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the end"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:margin-top: * * Margin on top side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_TOP] = g_param_spec_int ("margin-top", P_("Margin on Top"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the top side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:margin-bottom: * * Margin on bottom side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM] = g_param_spec_int ("margin-bottom", P_("Margin on Bottom"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the bottom side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:margin: * * Sets all four sides' margin at once. If read, returns max * margin on any side. * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_MARGIN] = g_param_spec_int ("margin", P_("All Margins"), P_("Pixels of extra space on all four sides"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); /** * GtkWidget:hexpand: * * Whether to expand horizontally. See gtk_widget_set_hexpand(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_HEXPAND] = g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand", P_("Horizontal Expand"), P_("Whether widget wants more horizontal space"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:hexpand-set: * * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:hexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_HEXPAND_SET] = g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand-set", P_("Horizontal Expand Set"), P_("Whether to use the hexpand property"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:vexpand: * * Whether to expand vertically. See gtk_widget_set_vexpand(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_VEXPAND] = g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand", P_("Vertical Expand"), P_("Whether widget wants more vertical space"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:vexpand-set: * * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:vexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_VEXPAND_SET] = g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand-set", P_("Vertical Expand Set"), P_("Whether to use the vexpand property"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:expand: * * Whether to expand in both directions. Setting this sets both #GtkWidget:hexpand and #GtkWidget:vexpand * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_props[PROP_EXPAND] = g_param_spec_boolean ("expand", P_("Expand Both"), P_("Whether widget wants to expand in both directions"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); /** * GtkWidget:opacity: * * The requested opacity of the widget. See gtk_widget_set_opacity() for * more details about window opacity. * * Before 3.8 this was only available in GtkWindow * * Since: 3.8 */ widget_props[PROP_OPACITY] = g_param_spec_double ("opacity", P_("Opacity for Widget"), P_("The opacity of the widget, from 0 to 1"), 0.0, 1.0, 1.0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); /** * GtkWidget:scale-factor: * * The scale factor of the widget. See gtk_widget_get_scale_factor() for * more details about widget scaling. * * Since: 3.10 */ widget_props[PROP_SCALE_FACTOR] = g_param_spec_int ("scale-factor", P_("Scale factor"), P_("The scaling factor of the window"), 1, G_MAXINT, 1, GTK_PARAM_READABLE); /** * GtkWidget:css-name: * * The name of this widget in the CSS tree. * * Since: 3.90 */ widget_props[PROP_CSS_NAME] = g_param_spec_string ("css-name", P_("CSS Name"), P_("The name of this widget in the CSS tree"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE | G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT_ONLY); g_object_class_install_properties (gobject_class, NUM_PROPERTIES, widget_props); /** * GtkWidget::destroy: * @object: the object which received the signal * * Signals that all holders of a reference to the widget should release * the reference that they hold. May result in finalization of the widget * if all references are released. * * This signal is not suitable for saving widget state. */ widget_signals[DESTROY] = g_signal_new (I_("destroy"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_CLEANUP | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::show: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::show signal is emitted when @widget is shown, for example with * gtk_widget_show(). */ widget_signals[SHOW] = g_signal_new (I_("show"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::hide: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::hide signal is emitted when @widget is hidden, for example with * gtk_widget_hide(). */ widget_signals[HIDE] = g_signal_new (I_("hide"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hide), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::map: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::map signal is emitted when @widget is going to be mapped, that is * when the widget is visible (which is controlled with * gtk_widget_set_visible()) and all its parents up to the toplevel widget * are also visible. * * The ::map signal can be used to determine whether a widget will be drawn, * for instance it can resume an animation that was stopped during the * emission of #GtkWidget::unmap. */ widget_signals[MAP] = g_signal_new (I_("map"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::unmap: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::unmap signal is emitted when @widget is going to be unmapped, which * means that either it or any of its parents up to the toplevel widget have * been set as hidden. * * As ::unmap indicates that a widget will not be shown any longer, it can be * used to, for example, stop an animation on the widget. */ widget_signals[UNMAP] = g_signal_new (I_("unmap"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::realize: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::realize signal is emitted when @widget is associated with a * #GdkWindow, which means that gtk_widget_realize() has been called or the * widget has been mapped (that is, it is going to be drawn). */ widget_signals[REALIZE] = g_signal_new (I_("realize"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, realize), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::unrealize: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::unrealize signal is emitted when the #GdkWindow associated with * @widget is destroyed, which means that gtk_widget_unrealize() has been * called or the widget has been unmapped (that is, it is going to be * hidden). */ widget_signals[UNREALIZE] = g_signal_new (I_("unrealize"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unrealize), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::size-allocate: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @allocation: (type Gtk.Allocation): the region which has been * allocated to the widget. * @baseline: the baseline * @out_clip: (out) (type Gtk.Allocation): Return address for the widget's clip */ widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE] = g_signal_new (I_("size-allocate"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, size_allocate), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 3, GDK_TYPE_RECTANGLE | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_INT, GDK_TYPE_RECTANGLE | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::state-flags-changed: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @flags: The previous state flags. * * The ::state-flags-changed signal is emitted when the widget state * changes, see gtk_widget_get_state_flags(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("state-flags-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_flags_changed), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_STATE_FLAGS); /** * GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_toplevel: (allow-none): the previous toplevel ancestor, or %NULL * if the widget was previously unanchored * * The ::hierarchy-changed signal is emitted when the * anchored state of a widget changes. A widget is * “anchored” when its toplevel * ancestor is a #GtkWindow. This signal is emitted when * a widget changes from un-anchored to anchored or vice-versa. */ widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("hierarchy-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hierarchy_changed), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET); /** * GtkWidget::style-updated: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * * The ::style-updated signal is a convenience signal that is emitted when the * #GtkStyleContext::changed signal is emitted on the @widget's associated * #GtkStyleContext as returned by gtk_widget_get_style_context(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED] = g_signal_new (I_("style-updated"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_updated), NULL, NULL, g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::direction-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_direction: the previous text direction of @widget * * The ::direction-changed signal is emitted when the text direction * of a widget changes. */ widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("direction-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, direction_changed), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_TEXT_DIRECTION); /** * GtkWidget::grab-notify: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @was_grabbed: %FALSE if the widget becomes shadowed, %TRUE * if it becomes unshadowed * * The ::grab-notify signal is emitted when a widget becomes * shadowed by a GTK+ grab (not a pointer or keyboard grab) on * another widget, or when it becomes unshadowed due to a grab * being removed. * * A widget is shadowed by a gtk_grab_add() when the topmost * grab widget in the grab stack of its window group is not * its ancestor. */ widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-notify"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_notify), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); /** * GtkWidget::child-notify: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @child_property: the #GParamSpec of the changed child property * * The ::child-notify signal is emitted for each * [child property][child-properties] that has * changed on an object. The signal's detail holds the property name. */ widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY] = g_signal_new (I_("child-notify"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_DETAILED | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, child_notify), NULL, NULL, g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__PARAM, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, G_TYPE_PARAM); /** * GtkWidget::draw: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @cr: the cairo context to draw to * * This signal is emitted when a widget is supposed to render itself. * The @widget's top left corner must be painted at the origin of * the passed in context and be sized to the values returned by * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width() and * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height(). * * Signal handlers connected to this signal can modify the cairo * context passed as @cr in any way they like and don't need to * restore it. The signal emission takes care of calling cairo_save() * before and cairo_restore() after invoking the handler. * * The signal handler will get a @cr with a clip region already set to the * widget's dirty region, i.e. to the area that needs repainting. Complicated * widgets that want to avoid redrawing themselves completely can get the full * extents of the clip region with gdk_cairo_get_clip_rectangle(), or they can * get a finer-grained representation of the dirty region with * cairo_copy_clip_rectangle_list(). * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_signals[DRAW] = g_signal_new (I_("draw"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, draw), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, gtk_widget_draw_marshaller, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, CAIRO_GOBJECT_TYPE_CONTEXT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[DRAW], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), gtk_widget_draw_marshallerv); /** * GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @group_cycling: %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic * * The default handler for this signal activates @widget if @group_cycling * is %FALSE, or just makes @widget grab focus if @group_cycling is %TRUE. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE] = g_signal_new (I_("mnemonic-activate"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, mnemonic_activate), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOOLEAN, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); /** * GtkWidget::grab-focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_focus), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @direction: * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::move-focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @direction: */ widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("move-focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, move_focus), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::keynav-failed: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @direction: the direction of movement * * Gets emitted if keyboard navigation fails. * See gtk_widget_keynav_failed() for details. * * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard * navigation attempt in its parent container(s). * * Since: 2.12 **/ widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED] = g_signal_new (I_("keynav-failed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, keynav_failed), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal * * The GTK+ main loop will emit three signals for each GDK event delivered * to a widget: one generic ::event signal, another, more specific, * signal that matches the type of event delivered (e.g. * #GtkWidget::key-press-event) and finally a generic * #GtkWidget::event-after signal. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event * and to cancel the emission of the second specific ::event signal. * %FALSE to propagate the event further and to allow the emission of * the second signal. The ::event-after signal is emitted regardless of * the return value. */ widget_signals[EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::event-after: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal * * After the emission of the #GtkWidget::event signal and (optionally) * the second more specific signal, ::event-after will be emitted * regardless of the previous two signals handlers return values. * */ widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER] = g_signal_new (I_("event-after"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); /** * GtkWidget::button-press-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered * this signal. * * The ::button-press-event signal will be emitted when a button * (typically from a mouse) is pressed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("button-press-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_press_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::button-release-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered * this signal. * * The ::button-release-event signal will be emitted when a button * (typically from a mouse) is released. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("button-release-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_release_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); widget_signals[TOUCH_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("touch-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, touch_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[TOUCH_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::scroll-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventScroll): the #GdkEventScroll which triggered * this signal. * * The ::scroll-event signal is emitted when a button in the 4 to 7 * range is pressed. Wheel mice are usually configured to generate * button press events for buttons 4 and 5 when the wheel is turned. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_SCROLL_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[SCROLL_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("scroll-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, scroll_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[SCROLL_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::motion-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventMotion): the #GdkEventMotion which triggered * this signal. * * The ::motion-notify-event signal is emitted when the pointer moves * over the widget's #GdkWindow. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget * needs to enable the #GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("motion-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, motion_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::delete-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: the event which triggered this signal * * The ::delete-event signal is emitted if a user requests that * a toplevel window is closed. The default handler for this signal * destroys the window. Connecting gtk_widget_hide_on_delete() to * this signal will cause the window to be hidden instead, so that * it can later be shown again without reconstructing it. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[DELETE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("delete-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, delete_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[DELETE_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::destroy-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the event which triggered this signal * * The ::destroy-event signal is emitted when a #GdkWindow is destroyed. * You rarely get this signal, because most widgets disconnect themselves * from their window before they destroy it, so no widget owns the * window at destroy time. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[DESTROY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("destroy-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[DESTROY_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::key-press-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal. * * The ::key-press-event signal is emitted when a key is pressed. The signal * emission will reoccur at the key-repeat rate when the key is kept pressed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[KEY_PRESS_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("key-press-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_press_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[KEY_PRESS_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::key-release-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal. * * The ::key-release-event signal is emitted when a key is released. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_KEY_RELEASE_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[KEY_RELEASE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("key-release-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_release_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[KEY_RELEASE_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::enter-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered * this signal. * * The ::enter-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer enters * the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("enter-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, enter_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::leave-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered * this signal. * * The ::leave-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer leaves * the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("leave-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, leave_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::configure-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventConfigure): the #GdkEventConfigure which triggered * this signal. * * The ::configure-event signal will be emitted when the size, position or * stacking of the @widget's window has changed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[CONFIGURE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("configure-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, configure_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[CONFIGURE_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::focus-in-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered * this signal. * * The ::focus-in-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus * enters the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS_IN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("focus-in-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_in_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[FOCUS_IN_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::focus-out-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered this * signal. * * The ::focus-out-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus * leaves the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS_OUT_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("focus-out-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_out_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[FOCUS_OUT_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::map-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal. * * The ::map-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is * mapped. A window is mapped when it becomes visible on the screen. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[MAP_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("map-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[MAP_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::unmap-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal * * The ::unmap-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is * unmapped. A window is unmapped when it becomes invisible on the screen. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[UNMAP_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("unmap-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[UNMAP_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::property-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProperty): the #GdkEventProperty which triggered * this signal. * * The ::property-notify-event signal will be emitted when a property on * the @widget's window has been changed or deleted. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROPERTY_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("property-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, property_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::selection-received: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @data: * @time: */ widget_signals[SELECTION_RECEIVED] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-received"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_received), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 2, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::selection-get: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @data: * @info: * @time: */ widget_signals[SELECTION_GET] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-get"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_get), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 2, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::proximity-in-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered * this signal. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_IN_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("proximity-in-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_in_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::proximity-out-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered * this signal. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("proximity-out-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_DEPRECATED, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_out_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::drag-leave: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @context: the drag context * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * * The ::drag-leave signal is emitted on the drop site when the cursor * leaves the widget. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to * undo things done in #GtkWidget::drag-motion, e.g. undo highlighting * with gtk_drag_unhighlight(). * * * Likewise, the #GtkWidget::drag-leave signal is also emitted before the * ::drag-drop signal, for instance to allow cleaning up of a preview item * created in the #GtkWidget::drag-motion signal handler. */ widget_signals[DRAG_LEAVE] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-leave"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_leave), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 2, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-begin: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * * The ::drag-begin signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is * started. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to set up a * custom drag icon with e.g. gtk_drag_source_set_icon_surface(). * * Note that some widgets set up a drag icon in the default handler of * this signal, so you may have to use g_signal_connect_after() to * override what the default handler did. */ widget_signals[DRAG_BEGIN] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-begin"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_begin), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-end: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * * The ::drag-end signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is * finished. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to undo * things done in #GtkWidget::drag-begin. */ widget_signals[DRAG_END] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-end"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_end), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-delete: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * * The ::drag-data-delete signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag * with the action %GDK_ACTION_MOVE is successfully completed. The signal * handler is responsible for deleting the data that has been dropped. What * "delete" means depends on the context of the drag operation. */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_DELETE] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-delete"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_delete), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-failed: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * @result: the result of the drag operation * * The ::drag-failed signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag has * failed. The signal handler may hook custom code to handle a failed DnD * operation based on the type of error, it returns %TRUE is the failure has * been already handled (not showing the default "drag operation failed" * animation), otherwise it returns %FALSE. * * Returns: %TRUE if the failed drag operation has been already handled. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_signals[DRAG_FAILED] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-failed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_failed), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 2, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, GTK_TYPE_DRAG_RESULT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-motion: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * * The ::drag-motion signal is emitted on the drop site when the user * moves the cursor over the widget during a drag. The signal handler * must determine whether the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. * If it is not in a drop zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing * is necessary. Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the * handler is responsible for providing the necessary information for * displaying feedback to the user, by calling gdk_drag_status(). * * If the decision whether the drop will be accepted or rejected can't be * made based solely on the cursor position and the type of the data, the * handler may inspect the dragged data by calling gtk_drag_get_data() and * defer the gdk_drag_status() call to the #GtkWidget::drag-data-received * handler. Note that you must pass #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_DROP, * #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_MOTION or #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_ALL to gtk_drag_dest_set() * when using the drag-motion signal that way. * * Also note that there is no drag-enter signal. The drag receiver has to * keep track of whether he has received any drag-motion signals since the * last #GtkWidget::drag-leave and if not, treat the drag-motion signal as * an "enter" signal. Upon an "enter", the handler will typically highlight * the drop site with gtk_drag_highlight(). * |[<!-- language="C" --> * static void * drag_motion (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *context, * gint x, * gint y, * guint time) * { * GdkAtom target; * * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); * * if (!private_data->drag_highlight) * { * private_data->drag_highlight = 1; * gtk_drag_highlight (widget); * } * * target = gtk_drag_dest_find_target (widget, context, NULL); * if (target == NULL) * gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time); * else * { * private_data->pending_status * = gdk_drag_context_get_suggested_action (context); * gtk_drag_get_data (widget, context, target, time); * } * * return TRUE; * } * * static void * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *context, * gint x, * gint y, * GtkSelectionData *selection_data, * guint info, * guint time) * { * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); * * if (private_data->suggested_action) * { * private_data->suggested_action = 0; * * // We are getting this data due to a request in drag_motion, * // rather than due to a request in drag_drop, so we are just * // supposed to call gdk_drag_status(), not actually paste in * // the data. * * str = gtk_selection_data_get_text (selection_data); * if (!data_is_acceptable (str)) * gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time); * else * gdk_drag_status (context, * private_data->suggested_action, * time); * } * else * { * // accept the drop * } * } * ]| * * Returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone */ widget_signals[DRAG_MOTION] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-motion"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_motion), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-drop: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * * The ::drag-drop signal is emitted on the drop site when the user drops * the data onto the widget. The signal handler must determine whether * the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. If it is not in a drop * zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing is necessary. * Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the handler must * ensure that gtk_drag_finish() is called to let the source know that * the drop is done. The call to gtk_drag_finish() can be done either * directly or in a #GtkWidget::drag-data-received handler which gets * triggered by calling gtk_drag_get_data() to receive the data for one * or more of the supported targets. * * Returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone */ widget_signals[DRAG_DROP] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-drop"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_drop), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-get: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * @data: the #GtkSelectionData to be filled with the dragged data * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the * #GtkTargetList * @time: the timestamp at which the data was requested * * The ::drag-data-get signal is emitted on the drag source when the drop * site requests the data which is dragged. It is the responsibility of * the signal handler to fill @data with the data in the format which * is indicated by @info. See gtk_selection_data_set() and * gtk_selection_data_set_text(). */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_GET] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-get"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_get), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 3, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-received: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @context: the drag context * @x: where the drop happened * @y: where the drop happened * @data: the received data * @time: the timestamp at which the data was received * * The ::drag-data-received signal is emitted on the drop site when the * dragged data has been received. If the data was received in order to * determine whether the drop will be accepted, the handler is expected * to call gdk_drag_status() and not finish the drag. * If the data was received in response to a #GtkWidget::drag-drop signal * (and this is the last target to be received), the handler for this * signal is expected to process the received data and then call * gtk_drag_finish(), setting the @success parameter depending on * whether the data was processed successfully. * * Applications must create some means to determine why the signal was emitted * and therefore whether to call gdk_drag_status() or gtk_drag_finish(). * * The handler may inspect the selected action with * gdk_drag_context_get_selected_action() before calling * gtk_drag_finish(), e.g. to implement %GDK_ACTION_ASK as * shown in the following example: * |[<!-- language="C" --> * void * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *context, * gint x, * gint y, * GtkSelectionData *data, * guint info, * guint time) * { * if ((data->length >= 0) && (data->format == 8)) * { * GdkDragAction action; * * // handle data here * * action = gdk_drag_context_get_selected_action (context); * if (action == GDK_ACTION_ASK) * { * GtkWidget *dialog; * gint response; * * dialog = gtk_message_dialog_new (NULL, * GTK_DIALOG_MODAL | * GTK_DIALOG_DESTROY_WITH_PARENT, * GTK_MESSAGE_INFO, * GTK_BUTTONS_YES_NO, * "Move the data ?\n"); * response = gtk_dialog_run (GTK_DIALOG (dialog)); * gtk_widget_destroy (dialog); * * if (response == GTK_RESPONSE_YES) * action = GDK_ACTION_MOVE; * else * action = GDK_ACTION_COPY; * } * * gtk_drag_finish (context, TRUE, action == GDK_ACTION_MOVE, time); * } * else * gtk_drag_finish (context, FALSE, FALSE, time); * } * ]| */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-received"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_received), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 3, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::window-state-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventWindowState): the #GdkEventWindowState which * triggered this signal. * * The ::window-state-event will be emitted when the state of the * toplevel window associated to the @widget changes. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget * needs to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable * this mask automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the * event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[WINDOW_STATE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("window-state-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, window_state_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[WINDOW_STATE_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::grab-broken-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventGrabBroken): the #GdkEventGrabBroken event * * Emitted when a pointer or keyboard grab on a window belonging * to @widget gets broken. * * On X11, this happens when the grab window becomes unviewable * (i.e. it or one of its ancestors is unmapped), or if the same * application grabs the pointer or keyboard again. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for * the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. * * Since: 2.8 */ widget_signals[GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-broken-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_broken_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT); g_signal_set_va_marshaller (widget_signals[GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT], G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECTv); /** * GtkWidget::query-tooltip: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @x: the x coordinate of the cursor position where the request has * been emitted, relative to @widget's left side * @y: the y coordinate of the cursor position where the request has * been emitted, relative to @widget's top * @keyboard_mode: %TRUE if the tooltip was triggered using the keyboard * @tooltip: a #GtkTooltip * * Emitted when #GtkWidget:has-tooltip is %TRUE and the hover timeout * has expired with the cursor hovering "above" @widget; or emitted when @widget got * focus in keyboard mode. * * Using the given coordinates, the signal handler should determine * whether a tooltip should be shown for @widget. If this is the case * %TRUE should be returned, %FALSE otherwise. Note that if * @keyboard_mode is %TRUE, the values of @x and @y are undefined and * should not be used. * * The signal handler is free to manipulate @tooltip with the therefore * destined function calls. * * Returns: %TRUE if @tooltip should be shown right now, %FALSE otherwise. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP] = g_signal_new (I_("query-tooltip"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, query_tooltip), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__INT_INT_BOOLEAN_OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, GTK_TYPE_TOOLTIP); /** * GtkWidget::popup-menu: * @widget: the object which received the signal * * This signal gets emitted whenever a widget should pop up a context * menu. This usually happens through the standard key binding mechanism; * by pressing a certain key while a widget is focused, the user can cause * the widget to pop up a menu. For example, the #GtkEntry widget creates * a menu with clipboard commands. See the * [Popup Menu Migration Checklist][checklist-popup-menu] * for an example of how to use this signal. * * Returns: %TRUE if a menu was activated */ widget_signals[POPUP_MENU] = g_signal_new (I_("popup-menu"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, popup_menu), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__VOID, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 0); /** * GtkWidget::accel-closures-changed: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * * The ::accel-closures-changed signal gets emitted when accelerators for this * widget get added, removed or changed. */ widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("accel-closures-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), 0, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::display-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_display: (allow-none): the previous screen, or %NULL if the * widget was not associated with a screen before * * The ::display-changed signal gets emitted when the * display of a widget has changed. */ widget_signals[DISPLAY_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("display-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, display_changed), NULL, NULL, NULL, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DISPLAY); /** * GtkWidget::can-activate-accel: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget * * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. * This signal is present to allow applications and derived * widgets to override the default #GtkWidget handling * for determining whether an accelerator can be activated. * * Returns: %TRUE if the signal can be activated. */ widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL] = g_signal_new (I_("can-activate-accel"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, can_activate_accel), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_UINT); binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (klass); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F10, GDK_SHIFT_MASK, "popup-menu", 0); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_Menu, 0, "popup-menu", 0); gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (klass, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_ACCESSIBLE); gtk_widget_class_set_css_name (klass, I_("widget")); } static void gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass) { template_data_free (klass->priv->template); } static void gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, const GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); switch (prop_id) { gboolean tmp; gchar *tooltip_markup; const gchar *tooltip_text; GtkWindow *tooltip_window; case PROP_NAME: gtk_widget_set_name (widget, g_value_get_string (value)); break; case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, g_value_get_int (value), -2); break; case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, -2, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_VISIBLE: gtk_widget_set_visible (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_SENSITIVE: gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: gtk_widget_set_can_focus (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); break; case PROP_IS_FOCUS: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); break; case PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK: gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT: gtk_widget_set_can_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_default (widget); break; case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: gtk_widget_set_receives_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_CURSOR: gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, g_value_get_object (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value), FALSE); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); tooltip_markup = g_value_dup_string (value); /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: */ if (tooltip_markup && (strlen (tooltip_markup) == 0)) { g_free (tooltip_markup); tooltip_markup = NULL; } g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, tooltip_markup, g_free); tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE); if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); tooltip_text = g_value_get_string (value); /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: */ if (tooltip_text && (strlen (tooltip_text) == 0)) tooltip_text = NULL; tooltip_markup = tooltip_text ? g_markup_escape_text (tooltip_text, -1) : NULL; g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, tooltip_markup, g_free); tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE); if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); break; case PROP_HALIGN: gtk_widget_set_halign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); break; case PROP_VALIGN: gtk_widget_set_valign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_START: gtk_widget_set_margin_start (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_END: gtk_widget_set_margin_end (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN: g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); gtk_widget_set_margin_start (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_end (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND: gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND: gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_EXPAND: g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); break; case PROP_OPACITY: gtk_widget_set_opacity (widget, g_value_get_double (value)); break; case PROP_CSS_NAME: if (g_value_get_string (value) != NULL) gtk_css_node_set_name (widget->priv->cssnode, g_intern_string (g_value_get_string (value))); else gtk_css_node_set_name (widget->priv->cssnode, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->priv->css_name); break; default: G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); break; } } static void gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; switch (prop_id) { case PROP_NAME: if (priv->name) g_value_set_string (value, priv->name); else g_value_set_static_string (value, ""); break; case PROP_PARENT: g_value_set_object (value, priv->parent); break; case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: { int w; gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, &w, NULL); g_value_set_int (value, w); } break; case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: { int h; gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, NULL, &h); g_value_set_int (value, h); } break; case PROP_VISIBLE: g_value_set_boolean (value, _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)); break; case PROP_SENSITIVE: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_sensitive (widget)); break; case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)); break; case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_has_focus (widget)); break; case PROP_IS_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)); break; case PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click (widget)); break; case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget)); break; case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_has_default (widget)); break; case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_receives_default (widget)); break; case PROP_CURSOR: g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_cursor (widget)); break; case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (widget)); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: { gchar *escaped = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup); gchar *text = NULL; if (escaped && !pango_parse_markup (escaped, -1, 0, NULL, &text, NULL, NULL)) g_assert (NULL == text); /* text should still be NULL in case of markup errors */ g_value_take_string (value, text); } break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: g_value_set_string (value, g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup)); break; case PROP_WINDOW: g_value_set_object (value, _gtk_widget_get_window (widget)); break; case PROP_HALIGN: g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_halign (widget)); break; case PROP_VALIGN: g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_valign (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_START: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_start (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_END: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_end (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_top (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN: g_value_set_int (value, MAX (MAX (priv->margin.left, priv->margin.right), MAX (priv->margin.top, priv->margin.bottom))); break; case PROP_HEXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (widget)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (widget)); break; case PROP_EXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget) && gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); break; case PROP_OPACITY: g_value_set_double (value, gtk_widget_get_opacity (widget)); break; case PROP_SCALE_FACTOR: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); break; case PROP_CSS_NAME: g_value_set_string (value, gtk_css_node_get_name (priv->cssnode)); break; default: G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); break; } } static void _gtk_widget_emulate_press (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event) { GtkWidget *event_widget, *next_child, *parent; GdkEvent *press; event_widget = gtk_get_event_target ((GdkEvent *) event); if (event_widget == widget) return; if (event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN || event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_UPDATE || event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_END) { press = gdk_event_copy (event); press->any.type = GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN; } else if (event->any.type == GDK_BUTTON_PRESS || event->any.type == GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE) { press = gdk_event_copy (event); press->any.type = GDK_BUTTON_PRESS; } else if (event->any.type == GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY) { press = gdk_event_new (GDK_BUTTON_PRESS); press->any.window = g_object_ref (event->any.window); press->button.time = event->motion.time; press->button.x = event->motion.x; press->button.y = event->motion.y; press->button.x_root = event->motion.x_root; press->button.y_root = event->motion.y_root; press->button.state = event->motion.state; press->button.axes = g_memdup (event->motion.axes, sizeof (gdouble) * gdk_device_get_n_axes (event->any.device)); if (event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON3_MASK) press->button.button = 3; else if (event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON2_MASK) press->button.button = 2; else { if ((event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK) == 0) g_critical ("Guessing button number 1 on generated button press event"); press->button.button = 1; } gdk_event_set_device (press, gdk_event_get_device (event)); gdk_event_set_source_device (press, gdk_event_get_source_device (event)); } else return; press->any.send_event = TRUE; next_child = event_widget; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (next_child); while (parent && parent != widget) { next_child = parent; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } /* Perform propagation state starting from the next child in the chain */ gtk_propagate_event_internal (event_widget, press, next_child); g_object_unref (press); } static const GdkEvent * _gtk_widget_get_last_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; EventControllerData *data; const GdkEvent *event; GList *l; for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { data = l->data; if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) continue; event = gtk_gesture_get_last_event (GTK_GESTURE (data->controller), sequence); if (event) return event; } return NULL; } static gboolean _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence, GdkEventSequence **sequence_out) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *l; *sequence_out = sequence; if (sequence) { const GdkEvent *last_event; last_event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, sequence); if (last_event && (last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN || last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_UPDATE || last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_END) && last_event->touch.emulating_pointer) return TRUE; } else { /* For a NULL(pointer) sequence, find the pointer emulating one */ for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { EventControllerData *data = l->data; if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) continue; if (_gtk_gesture_get_pointer_emulating_sequence (GTK_GESTURE (data->controller), sequence_out)) return TRUE; } } return FALSE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_needs_press_emulation (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; gboolean sequence_press_handled = FALSE; GList *l; /* Check whether there is any remaining gesture in * the capture phase that handled the press event */ for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { EventControllerData *data; GtkPropagationPhase phase; GtkGesture *gesture; data = l->data; phase = gtk_event_controller_get_propagation_phase (data->controller); if (phase != GTK_PHASE_CAPTURE) continue; if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) continue; gesture = GTK_GESTURE (data->controller); sequence_press_handled |= (gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, sequence) && _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, sequence)); } return !sequence_press_handled; } static gint _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence, GtkEventSequenceState state, GtkGesture *emitter) { gboolean emulates_pointer, sequence_handled = FALSE; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; const GdkEvent *mimic_event; GList *group = NULL, *l; GdkEventSequence *seq; gint n_handled = 0; if (!priv->event_controllers && state != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) return TRUE; if (emitter) group = gtk_gesture_get_group (emitter); emulates_pointer = _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (widget, sequence, &seq); mimic_event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, seq); for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { GtkEventSequenceState gesture_state; EventControllerData *data; GtkGesture *gesture; gboolean retval; seq = sequence; data = l->data; gesture_state = state; if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) continue; gesture = GTK_GESTURE (data->controller); if (gesture == emitter) { sequence_handled |= _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, sequence); n_handled++; continue; } if (seq && emulates_pointer && !gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) seq = NULL; if (group && !g_list_find (group, data->controller)) { /* If a group is provided, ensure only gestures pertaining to the group * get a "claimed" state, all other claiming gestures must deny the sequence. */ if (gesture_state == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED && gtk_gesture_get_sequence_state (gesture, sequence) == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) gesture_state = GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED; else continue; } else if (!group && gtk_gesture_get_sequence_state (gesture, sequence) != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) continue; g_signal_handler_block (data->controller, data->sequence_state_changed_id); retval = gtk_gesture_set_sequence_state (gesture, seq, gesture_state); g_signal_handler_unblock (data->controller, data->sequence_state_changed_id); if (retval || gesture == emitter) { sequence_handled |= _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, seq); n_handled++; } } /* If the sequence goes denied, check whether this is a controller attached * to the capture phase, that additionally handled the button/touch press (i.e. * it was consumed), the corresponding press will be emulated for widgets * beneath, so the widgets beneath get a coherent stream of events from now on. */ if (n_handled > 0 && sequence_handled && state == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED && gtk_widget_needs_press_emulation (widget, sequence)) _gtk_widget_emulate_press (widget, mimic_event); g_list_free (group); return n_handled; } static gboolean _gtk_widget_cancel_sequence (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; gboolean emulates_pointer; gboolean handled = FALSE; GdkEventSequence *seq; GList *l; emulates_pointer = _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (widget, sequence, &seq); for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { EventControllerData *data; GtkGesture *gesture; seq = sequence; data = l->data; if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) continue; gesture = GTK_GESTURE (data->controller); if (seq && emulates_pointer && !gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) seq = NULL; if (!gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) continue; handled |= _gtk_gesture_cancel_sequence (gesture, seq); } return handled; } static void gtk_widget_init (GTypeInstance *instance, gpointer g_class) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (instance); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; widget->priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); priv = widget->priv; priv->visible = gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (g_class); priv->child_visible = TRUE; priv->name = NULL; priv->allocation.x = -1; priv->allocation.y = -1; priv->allocation.width = 0; priv->allocation.height = 0; priv->clip = priv->allocation; priv->user_alpha = 255; priv->alpha = 255; priv->window = NULL; priv->parent = NULL; priv->first_child = NULL; priv->last_child = NULL; priv->prev_sibling = NULL; priv->next_sibling = NULL; priv->allocated_baseline = -1; priv->allocated_size_baseline = -1; priv->sensitive = TRUE; priv->alloc_needed = TRUE; priv->alloc_needed_on_child = TRUE; priv->focus_on_click = TRUE; #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG priv->highlight_resize = FALSE; #endif switch (_gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)) { case GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR: priv->state_flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR; break; case GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL: priv->state_flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL; break; case GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE: default: g_assert_not_reached (); break; } /* this will be set to TRUE if the widget gets a child or if the * expand flag is set on the widget, but until one of those happen * we know the expand is already properly FALSE. * * We really want to default FALSE here to avoid computing expand * all over the place while initially building a widget tree. */ priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; priv->halign = GTK_ALIGN_FILL; priv->valign = GTK_ALIGN_FILL; priv->width = -1; priv->height = -1; _gtk_size_request_cache_init (&priv->requests); priv->cssnode = gtk_css_widget_node_new (widget); gtk_css_node_set_state (priv->cssnode, priv->state_flags); gtk_css_node_set_visible (priv->cssnode, priv->visible); /* need to set correct type here, and only class has the correct type here */ gtk_css_node_set_widget_type (priv->cssnode, G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (g_class)); gtk_widget_init_legacy_controller (widget); } static void gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed (GtkWidget *widget, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkWidget *container = priv->parent; guint i; for (i = 0; widget->priv->parent == container && i < n_pspecs; i++) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY], g_param_spec_get_name_quark (pspecs[i]), pspecs[i]); } /** * gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Stops emission of #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget. The * signals are queued until gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify() is called * on @widget. * * This is the analogue of g_object_freeze_notify() for child properties. **/ void gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count) return; g_object_ref (widget); g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @child_property: the name of a child property installed on the * class of @widget’s parent * * Emits a #GtkWidget::child-notify signal for the * [child property][child-properties] @child_property * on @widget. * * This is the analogue of g_object_notify() for child properties. * * Also see gtk_container_child_notify(). */ void gtk_widget_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *child_property) { if (widget->priv->parent == NULL) return; gtk_container_child_notify (GTK_CONTAINER (widget->priv->parent), widget, child_property); } /** * gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Reverts the effect of a previous call to gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify(). * This causes all queued #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget to be * emitted. */ void gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget) { GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count) return; g_object_ref (widget); nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_from_object (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); if (!nqueue || !nqueue->freeze_count) g_warning (G_STRLOC ": child-property-changed notification for %s(%p) is not frozen", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); else g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_new: * @type: type ID of the widget to create * @first_property_name: name of first property to set * @...: value of first property, followed by more properties, * %NULL-terminated * * This is a convenience function for creating a widget and setting * its properties in one go. For example you might write: * `gtk_widget_new (GTK_TYPE_LABEL, "label", "Hello World", "xalign", * 0.0, NULL)` to create a left-aligned label. Equivalent to * g_object_new(), but returns a widget so you don’t have to * cast the object yourself. * * Returns: a new #GtkWidget of type @widget_type **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_new (GType type, const gchar *first_property_name, ...) { GtkWidget *widget; va_list var_args; g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET), NULL); va_start (var_args, first_property_name); widget = (GtkWidget *)g_object_new_valist (type, first_property_name, var_args); va_end (var_args); return widget; } /** * gtk_widget_unparent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. * Should be called by parent widgets to dissociate @widget * from the parent. **/ void gtk_widget_unparent (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue; GtkWidget *toplevel; GtkWidget *old_parent; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->parent == NULL) return; /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_detach() */ gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); if (gtk_widget_get_focus_child (priv->parent) == widget) gtk_widget_set_focus_child (priv->parent, NULL); if (_gtk_widget_is_drawable (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (priv->parent, priv->clip.x, priv->clip.y, priv->clip.width, priv->clip.height); if (priv->visible && _gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_queue_resize (priv->parent); /* Reset the width and height here, to force reallocation if we * get added back to a new parent. */ priv->allocation.width = 0; priv->allocation.height = 0; if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); /* If we are unanchoring the child, we save around the toplevel * to emit hierarchy changed */ if (priv->parent->priv->anchored) g_object_ref (toplevel); else toplevel = NULL; /* Removing a widget from a container restores the child visible * flag to the default state, so it doesn't affect the child * in the next parent. */ priv->child_visible = TRUE; old_parent = priv->parent; if (old_parent) { if (old_parent->priv->first_child == widget) old_parent->priv->first_child = priv->next_sibling; if (old_parent->priv->last_child == widget) old_parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; if (priv->prev_sibling) priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; if (priv->next_sibling) priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; } priv->parent = NULL; priv->prev_sibling = NULL; priv->next_sibling = NULL; /* parent may no longer expand if the removed * child was expand=TRUE and could therefore * be forcing it to. */ if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && (priv->need_compute_expand || priv->computed_hexpand || priv->computed_vexpand)) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (old_parent); } /* Unset BACKDROP since we are no longer inside a toplevel window */ gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_BACKDROP); if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, NULL); gtk_css_node_set_parent (widget->priv->cssnode, NULL); _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); if (toplevel) { _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, toplevel); g_object_unref (toplevel); } /* Now that the parent pointer is nullified and the hierarchy-changed * already passed, go ahead and unset the parent window, if we are unparenting * an embedded GtkWindow the window will become toplevel again and hierarchy-changed * will fire again for the new subhierarchy. */ gtk_widget_set_parent_window (widget, NULL); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_PARENT]); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); if (!priv->parent) g_object_notify_queue_clear (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_destroy: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Destroys a widget. * * When a widget is destroyed all references it holds on other objects * will be released: * * - if the widget is inside a container, it will be removed from its * parent * - if the widget is a container, all its children will be destroyed, * recursively * - if the widget is a top level, it will be removed from the list * of top level widgets that GTK+ maintains internally * * It's expected that all references held on the widget will also * be released; you should connect to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal * if you hold a reference to @widget and you wish to remove it when * this function is called. It is not necessary to do so if you are * implementing a #GtkContainer, as you'll be able to use the * #GtkContainerClass.remove() virtual function for that. * * It's important to notice that gtk_widget_destroy() will only cause * the @widget to be finalized if no additional references, acquired * using g_object_ref(), are held on it. In case additional references * are in place, the @widget will be in an "inert" state after calling * this function; @widget will still point to valid memory, allowing you * to release the references you hold, but you may not query the widget's * own state. * * You should typically call this function on top level widgets, and * rarely on child widgets. * * See also: gtk_container_remove() */ void gtk_widget_destroy (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!widget->priv->in_destruction) g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_destroyed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @widget_pointer: (inout) (transfer none): address of a variable that contains @widget * * This function sets *@widget_pointer to %NULL if @widget_pointer != * %NULL. It’s intended to be used as a callback connected to the * “destroy” signal of a widget. You connect gtk_widget_destroyed() * as a signal handler, and pass the address of your widget variable * as user data. Then when the widget is destroyed, the variable will * be set to %NULL. Useful for example to avoid multiple copies * of the same dialog. **/ void gtk_widget_destroyed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget **widget_pointer) { /* Don't make any assumptions about the * value of widget! * Even check widget_pointer. */ if (widget_pointer) *widget_pointer = NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_show: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Flags a widget to be displayed. Any widget that isn’t shown will * not appear on the screen. * * Remember that you have to show the containers containing a widget, * in addition to the widget itself, before it will appear onscreen. * * When a toplevel container is shown, it is immediately realized and * mapped; other shown widgets are realized and mapped when their * toplevel container is realized and mapped. **/ void gtk_widget_show (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { GtkWidget *parent; g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); if (parent) { gtk_widget_queue_resize (parent); /* see comment in set_parent() for why this should and can be * conditional */ if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand || widget->priv->computed_hexpand || widget->priv->computed_vexpand) gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent); } gtk_css_node_set_visible (widget->priv->cssnode, TRUE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SHOW], 0); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE]); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { priv->visible = TRUE; if (priv->parent && _gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && _gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && !_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) gtk_widget_map (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_show_map_callback (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event, gint *flag) { *flag = TRUE; g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (widget, gtk_widget_show_map_callback, flag); } /** * gtk_widget_show_now: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Shows a widget. If the widget is an unmapped toplevel widget * (i.e. a #GtkWindow that has not yet been shown), enter the main * loop and wait for the window to actually be mapped. Be careful; * because the main loop is running, anything can happen during * this function. **/ void gtk_widget_show_now (GtkWidget *widget) { gint flag = FALSE; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* make sure we will get event */ if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget) && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { gtk_widget_show (widget); g_signal_connect (widget, "map-event", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_show_map_callback), &flag); while (!flag) gtk_main_iteration (); } else gtk_widget_show (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_hide: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Reverses the effects of gtk_widget_show(), causing the widget to be * hidden (invisible to the user). **/ void gtk_widget_hide (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); GtkWidget *parent; g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (toplevel != widget && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); /* a parent may now be expand=FALSE since we're hidden. */ if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand || widget->priv->computed_hexpand || widget->priv->computed_vexpand) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); } gtk_css_node_set_visible (widget->priv->cssnode, FALSE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIDE], 0); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE]); parent = gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); if (parent) gtk_widget_queue_resize (parent); gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget) { if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { widget->priv->visible = FALSE; if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) gtk_widget_unmap (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_hide_on_delete: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Utility function; intended to be connected to the #GtkWidget::delete-event * signal on a #GtkWindow. The function calls gtk_widget_hide() on its * argument, then returns %TRUE. If connected to ::delete-event, the * result is that clicking the close button for a window (on the * window frame, top right corner usually) will hide but not destroy * the window. By default, GTK+ destroys windows when ::delete-event * is received. * * Returns: %TRUE **/ gboolean gtk_widget_hide_on_delete (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); gtk_widget_hide (widget); return TRUE; } static void update_cursor_on_state_change (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) return; gtk_window_update_pointer_focus_on_state_change (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); } /** * gtk_widget_map: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes * a widget to be mapped if it isn’t already. **/ void gtk_widget_map (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget)); if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_realize (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MAP], 0); update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); if (!_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_unmap: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes * a widget to be unmapped if it’s currently mapped. **/ void gtk_widget_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNMAP], 0); update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } } typedef struct _GtkTickCallbackInfo GtkTickCallbackInfo; struct _GtkTickCallbackInfo { guint refcount; guint id; GtkTickCallback callback; gpointer user_data; GDestroyNotify notify; guint destroyed : 1; }; static void ref_tick_callback_info (GtkTickCallbackInfo *info) { info->refcount++; } static void unref_tick_callback_info (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTickCallbackInfo *info, GList *link) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; info->refcount--; if (info->refcount == 0) { priv->tick_callbacks = g_list_delete_link (priv->tick_callbacks, link); if (info->notify) info->notify (info->user_data); g_slice_free (GtkTickCallbackInfo, info); } if (priv->tick_callbacks == NULL && priv->clock_tick_id) { GdkFrameClock *frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); g_signal_handler_disconnect (frame_clock, priv->clock_tick_id); priv->clock_tick_id = 0; gdk_frame_clock_end_updating (frame_clock); } } static void destroy_tick_callback_info (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTickCallbackInfo *info, GList *link) { if (!info->destroyed) { info->destroyed = TRUE; unref_tick_callback_info (widget, info, link); } } static void destroy_tick_callbacks (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *l; for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l;) { GList *next = l->next; destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, l->data, l); l = next; } } static void gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update (GdkFrameClock *frame_clock, GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *l; g_object_ref (widget); for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l;) { GtkTickCallbackInfo *info = l->data; GList *next; ref_tick_callback_info (info); if (!info->destroyed) { if (info->callback (widget, frame_clock, info->user_data) == G_SOURCE_REMOVE) { destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); } } next = l->next; unref_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); l = next; } g_object_unref (widget); } static guint tick_callback_id; /** * gtk_widget_add_tick_callback: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @callback: function to call for updating animations * @user_data: data to pass to @callback * @notify: function to call to free @user_data when the callback is removed. * * Queues an animation frame update and adds a callback to be called * before each frame. Until the tick callback is removed, it will be * called frequently (usually at the frame rate of the output device * or as quickly as the application can be repainted, whichever is * slower). For this reason, is most suitable for handling graphics * that change every frame or every few frames. The tick callback does * not automatically imply a relayout or repaint. If you want a * repaint or relayout, and aren’t changing widget properties that * would trigger that (for example, changing the text of a #GtkLabel), * then you will have to call gtk_widget_queue_resize() or * gtk_widget_queue_draw_area() yourself. * * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time() should generally be used for timing * continuous animations and * gdk_frame_timings_get_predicted_presentation_time() if you are * trying to display isolated frames at particular times. * * This is a more convenient alternative to connecting directly to the * #GdkFrameClock::update signal of #GdkFrameClock, since you don't * have to worry about when a #GdkFrameClock is assigned to a widget. * * Returns: an id for the connection of this callback. Remove the callback * by passing it to gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback() * * Since: 3.8 */ guint gtk_widget_add_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTickCallback callback, gpointer user_data, GDestroyNotify notify) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkTickCallbackInfo *info; GdkFrameClock *frame_clock; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->realized && !priv->clock_tick_id) { frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); if (frame_clock) { priv->clock_tick_id = g_signal_connect (frame_clock, "update", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update), widget); gdk_frame_clock_begin_updating (frame_clock); } } info = g_slice_new0 (GtkTickCallbackInfo); info->refcount = 1; info->id = ++tick_callback_id; info->callback = callback; info->user_data = user_data; info->notify = notify; priv->tick_callbacks = g_list_prepend (priv->tick_callbacks, info); return info->id; } /** * gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @id: an id returned by gtk_widget_add_tick_callback() * * Removes a tick callback previously registered with * gtk_widget_add_tick_callback(). * * Since: 3.8 */ void gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget, guint id) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GList *l; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l; l = l->next) { GtkTickCallbackInfo *info = l->data; if (info->id == id) { destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); return; } } } gboolean gtk_widget_has_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->tick_callbacks != NULL; } static void gtk_widget_connect_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget, GdkFrameClock *frame_clock) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) _gtk_container_maybe_start_idle_sizer (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); if (priv->tick_callbacks != NULL && !priv->clock_tick_id) { priv->clock_tick_id = g_signal_connect (frame_clock, "update", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update), widget); gdk_frame_clock_begin_updating (frame_clock); } gtk_css_node_invalidate_frame_clock (priv->cssnode, FALSE); if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_frame_clock (priv->context, frame_clock); } static void gtk_widget_disconnect_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget, GdkFrameClock *frame_clock) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) _gtk_container_stop_idle_sizer (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); gtk_css_node_invalidate_frame_clock (priv->cssnode, FALSE); if (priv->clock_tick_id) { g_signal_handler_disconnect (frame_clock, priv->clock_tick_id); priv->clock_tick_id = 0; gdk_frame_clock_end_updating (frame_clock); } if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_frame_clock (priv->context, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_realize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Creates the GDK (windowing system) resources associated with a * widget. For example, @widget->window will be created when a widget * is realized. Normally realization happens implicitly; if you show * a widget and all its parent containers, then the widget will be * realized and mapped automatically. * * Realizing a widget requires all * the widget’s parent widgets to be realized; calling * gtk_widget_realize() realizes the widget’s parents in addition to * @widget itself. If a widget is not yet inside a toplevel window * when you realize it, bad things will happen. * * This function is primarily used in widget implementations, and * isn’t very useful otherwise. Many times when you think you might * need it, a better approach is to connect to a signal that will be * called after the widget is realized automatically, such as * #GtkWidget::draw. Or simply g_signal_connect () to the * #GtkWidget::realize signal. **/ void gtk_widget_realize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; cairo_region_t *region; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (widget->priv->anchored || GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); /* if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) g_message ("gtk_widget_realize(%s)", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); */ if (priv->parent == NULL && !_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) g_warning ("Calling gtk_widget_realize() on a widget that isn't " "inside a toplevel window is not going to work very well. " "Widgets must be inside a toplevel container before realizing them."); if (priv->parent && !_gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_realize (priv->parent); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[REALIZE], 0); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (widget), TRUE); if (priv->has_shape_mask) { region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info); gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); } gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); if (priv->multidevice) gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, TRUE); gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); gtk_widget_connect_frame_clock (widget, gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget)); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_unrealize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only useful in widget implementations. * Causes a widget to be unrealized (frees all GDK resources * associated with the widget, such as @widget->window). **/ void gtk_widget_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (widget->priv->has_shape_mask) gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL); if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info)) gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { if (widget->priv->mapped) gtk_widget_unmap (widget); gtk_widget_disconnect_frame_clock (widget, gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget)); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNREALIZE], 0); g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped); gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE); } gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } /* * Returns the values you're supposed to pass to gdk_window_move_resize * for a windowed widget. */ void gtk_widget_get_window_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidget *parent; GtkAllocation alloc; /* Don't consider the parent == widget case here. */ parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); while (parent && !_gtk_widget_get_has_window (parent)) parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); g_assert (GTK_IS_WINDOW (parent) || GTK_IS_POPOVER (parent)); gtk_widget_get_own_allocation (widget, &alloc); gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (widget, parent, alloc.x, alloc.y, &alloc.x, &alloc.y); *allocation = alloc; } /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw_area: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @x: x coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw * @y: y coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw * @width: width of region to draw * @height: height of region to draw * * Convenience function that calls gtk_widget_queue_draw_region() on * the region created from the given coordinates. * * The region here is specified in widget coordinates of @widget. * * @width or @height may be 0, in this case this function does * nothing. Negative values for @width and @height are not allowed. */ void gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gint width, gint height) { GdkRectangle rect; cairo_region_t *region; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (width >= 0); g_return_if_fail (height >= 0); if (width == 0 || height == 0) return; rect.x = x; rect.y = y; rect.width = width; rect.height = height; region = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect); gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (widget, region); cairo_region_destroy (region); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Equivalent to calling gtk_widget_queue_draw_area() for the * entire area of a widget. **/ void gtk_widget_queue_draw (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; GdkRectangle *rect; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); rect = &widget->priv->clip; if (!_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (parent ? parent : widget, rect->x, rect->y, rect->width, rect->height); else gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget, 0, 0, rect->width, rect->height); } static void gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget); /** * gtk_widget_queue_allocate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. * * Flags the widget for a rerun of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate * function. Use this function instead of gtk_widget_queue_resize() * when the @widget's size request didn't change but it wants to * reposition its contents. * * An example user of this function is gtk_widget_set_halign(). * * Since: 3.20 */ void gtk_widget_queue_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (widget); } static inline gboolean gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->resize_needed; } /* * gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Queue a resize on a widget, and on all other widgets grouped with this widget. */ static void gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (GtkWidget *widget) { GSList *groups, *l, *widgets; if (gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) return; widget->priv->resize_needed = TRUE; gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (widget); groups = _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (widget); for (l = groups; l; l = l->next) { for (widgets = gtk_size_group_get_widgets (l->data); widgets; widgets = widgets->next) { gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widgets->data); } } if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { gtk_container_queue_resize_handler (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); } else if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { GtkWidget *parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); if (parent) gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (parent); } } /** * gtk_widget_queue_resize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. * Flags a widget to have its size renegotiated; should * be called when a widget for some reason has a new size request. * For example, when you change the text in a #GtkLabel, #GtkLabel * queues a resize to ensure there’s enough space for the new text. * * Note that you cannot call gtk_widget_queue_resize() on a widget * from inside its implementation of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate * virtual method. Calls to gtk_widget_queue_resize() from inside * GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate will be silently ignored. **/ void gtk_widget_queue_resize (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function works like gtk_widget_queue_resize(), * except that the widget is not invalidated. * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_frame_clock: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Obtains the frame clock for a widget. The frame clock is a global * “ticker” that can be used to drive animations and repaints. The * most common reason to get the frame clock is to call * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time(), in order to get a time to use for * animating. For example you might record the start of the animation * with an initial value from gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time(), and * then update the animation by calling * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time() again during each repaint. * * gdk_frame_clock_request_phase() will result in a new frame on the * clock, but won’t necessarily repaint any widgets. To repaint a * widget, you have to use gtk_widget_queue_draw() which invalidates * the widget (thus scheduling it to receive a draw on the next * frame). gtk_widget_queue_draw() will also end up requesting a frame * on the appropriate frame clock. * * A widget’s frame clock will not change while the widget is * mapped. Reparenting a widget (which implies a temporary unmap) can * change the widget’s frame clock. * * Unrealized widgets do not have a frame clock. * * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): a #GdkFrameClock, * or %NULL if widget is unrealized * * Since: 3.8 */ GdkFrameClock* gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); if (widget->priv->realized) { /* We use gtk_widget_get_toplevel() here to make it explicit that * the frame clock is a property of the toplevel that a widget * is anchored to; gdk_window_get_toplevel() will go up the * hierarchy anyways, but should squash any funny business with * reparenting windows and widgets. */ GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); GdkWindow *window = _gtk_widget_get_window (toplevel); g_assert (window != NULL); return gdk_window_get_frame_clock (window); } else { return NULL; } } static gint get_number (GtkCssStyle *style, guint property) { double d = _gtk_css_number_value_get (gtk_css_style_get_value (style, property), 100); if (d < 1) return ceil (d); else return floor (d); } static void get_box_margin (GtkCssStyle *style, GtkBorder *margin) { margin->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_TOP); margin->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_LEFT); margin->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_BOTTOM); margin->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_RIGHT); } static void get_box_border (GtkCssStyle *style, GtkBorder *border) { border->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_TOP_WIDTH); border->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_LEFT_WIDTH); border->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_BOTTOM_WIDTH); border->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_RIGHT_WIDTH); } static void get_box_padding (GtkCssStyle *style, GtkBorder *border) { border->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_TOP); border->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_LEFT); border->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_BOTTOM); border->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_RIGHT); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: region to draw, in @widget's coordinates * * Invalidates the area of @widget defined by @region. Makes sure * that the compositor updates the speicifed region of the toplevel * window. * * Normally you would only use this function in widget * implementations. You might also use it to schedule a redraw of a * #GtkDrawingArea or some portion thereof. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (GtkWidget *widget, const cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidget *windowed_parent; cairo_region_t *region2; int x, y; GtkCssStyle *parent_style; GtkBorder border, padding; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (cairo_region_is_empty (region)) return; /* Just return if the widget isn't mapped */ if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) return; if (!_gtk_widget_get_parent (widget)) { g_assert (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); region2 = cairo_region_copy (region); windowed_parent = widget; goto invalidate; } /* Look for the parent with a window and invalidate @region in there. */ windowed_parent = widget; while (windowed_parent != NULL && !_gtk_widget_get_has_window (windowed_parent)) windowed_parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (windowed_parent); g_assert (windowed_parent != NULL); /* @region's coordinates are originally relative to @widget's origin */ if (widget != windowed_parent) gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (widget, windowed_parent, 0, 0, &x, &y); else x = y = 0; /* At this point, x and y are relative to the windowed parent's origin, * but the window of the parent spans over its entire allocation, so we need * to account for border and padding manually. The values returned from * gtk_widget_get_window_allocation, which should've been used to size and position * @parent's window, do not include widget margins nor css margins. */ parent_style = gtk_css_node_get_style (windowed_parent->priv->cssnode); get_box_border (parent_style, &border); get_box_padding (parent_style, &padding); x += border.left + padding.left; y += border.top + padding.top; region2 = cairo_region_copy (region); cairo_region_translate (region2, x, y); invalidate: gtk_debug_updates_add (windowed_parent, region2); gdk_window_invalidate_region (_gtk_widget_get_window (widget), region2, TRUE); cairo_region_destroy (region2); } /** * gtk_widget_size_allocate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: position and size to be allocated to @widget * @baseline: The baseline of the child, or -1 * @out_clip: (out): Return location for @widget's clip region. The returned clip * will be in the coordinate system of @widget's parent, just like @allocation. * * This function is only used by #GtkWidget subclasses, to assign a size, * position and (optionally) baseline to their child widgets. * * In this function, the allocation and baseline may be adjusted. The given * allocation will be forced to be bigger than the widget's minimum size, * as well as at least 0×0 in size. * * Since: 3.10 **/ void gtk_widget_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *allocation, int baseline, GtkAllocation *out_clip) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GdkRectangle real_allocation; GdkRectangle old_clip; GdkRectangle adjusted_allocation; gboolean alloc_needed; gboolean size_changed; gboolean baseline_changed; gboolean position_changed; gint natural_width, natural_height, dummy; gint min_width, min_height; GtkCssStyle *style; GtkBorder margin, border, padding; GtkAllocation new_clip; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (baseline >= -1); g_return_if_fail (out_clip != NULL); g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!priv->visible && !_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { memset (out_clip, 0, sizeof (GdkRectangle)); goto out; } #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (RESIZE) && GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (gtk_widget_get_display (widget), RESIZE)) { priv->highlight_resize = TRUE; gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); } if (gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) { g_warning ("Allocating size to %s %p without calling gtk_widget_measure(). " "How does the code know the size to allocate?", gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); } if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (GEOMETRY)) { gint depth; GtkWidget *parent; const gchar *name; depth = 0; parent = widget; while (parent) { depth++; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } name = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (G_OBJECT (widget))); g_message ("gtk_widget_size_allocate: %*s%s %d %d %d %d, baseline %d", 2 * depth, " ", name, allocation->x, allocation->y, allocation->width, allocation->height, baseline); } #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ alloc_needed = priv->alloc_needed; /* Preserve request/allocate ordering */ priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; old_clip = priv->clip; real_allocation = *allocation; priv->allocated_size = *allocation; priv->allocated_size_baseline = baseline; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); adjusted_allocation = real_allocation; if (gtk_widget_get_request_mode (widget) == GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH) { /* Go ahead and request the height for allocated width, note that the internals * of get_height_for_width will internally limit the for_size to natural size * when aligning implicitly. */ gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, -1, &min_width, &natural_width, NULL, NULL); gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, real_allocation.width, &min_height, &natural_height, NULL, NULL); } else { /* Go ahead and request the width for allocated height, note that the internals * of get_width_for_height will internally limit the for_size to natural size * when aligning implicitly. */ gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, -1, &min_height, &natural_height, NULL, NULL); gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, real_allocation.height, &min_width, &natural_width, NULL, NULL); } #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS if ((min_width > real_allocation.width || min_height > real_allocation.height) && !GTK_IS_SCROLLABLE (widget)) g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to underallocate %s%s %s %p. " "Allocation is %dx%d, but minimum required size is %dx%d.", priv->parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (priv->parent) : "", priv->parent ? "'s child" : "toplevel", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height, min_width, min_height); #endif /* Now that we have the right natural height and width, go ahead and remove any margins from the * allocated sizes and possibly limit them to the natural sizes */ gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, &dummy, &natural_width, &adjusted_allocation.x, &adjusted_allocation.width); gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, &dummy, &natural_height, &adjusted_allocation.y, &adjusted_allocation.height); if (baseline >= 0) { gtk_widget_adjust_baseline_allocation (widget, &baseline); baseline -= margin.top + border.top + padding.top; } if (adjusted_allocation.x < real_allocation.x || adjusted_allocation.y < real_allocation.y || (adjusted_allocation.x + adjusted_allocation.width) > (real_allocation.x + real_allocation.width) || (adjusted_allocation.y + adjusted_allocation.height > real_allocation.y + real_allocation.height)) { g_warning ("%s %p attempted to adjust its size allocation from %d,%d %dx%d to %d,%d %dx%d. adjust_size_allocation must keep allocation inside original bounds", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, real_allocation.x, real_allocation.y, real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height, adjusted_allocation.x, adjusted_allocation.y, adjusted_allocation.width, adjusted_allocation.height); } else { real_allocation = adjusted_allocation; } if (real_allocation.width < 0 || real_allocation.height < 0) { g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to allocate widget with width %d and height %d", real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height); real_allocation.width = 0; real_allocation.height = 0; } if (G_UNLIKELY (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget))) { real_allocation.width = MAX (1, real_allocation.width); real_allocation.height = MAX (1, real_allocation.height); } baseline_changed = priv->allocated_baseline != baseline; size_changed = (priv->allocation.width != real_allocation.width || priv->allocation.height != real_allocation.height); position_changed = (priv->allocation.x != real_allocation.x || priv->allocation.y != real_allocation.y); /* Set the widget allocation to real_allocation now, pass the smaller allocation to the vfunc */ priv->allocation = real_allocation; priv->allocated_baseline = baseline; if (!alloc_needed && !size_changed && !baseline_changed) { gtk_widget_set_clip (widget, &priv->reported_clip); *out_clip = priv->clip; /* Still have to move the window... */ if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { GtkAllocation window_alloc; gtk_widget_get_window_allocation (widget, &window_alloc); gdk_window_move_resize (priv->window, window_alloc.x, window_alloc.y, window_alloc.width, window_alloc.height); } goto check_clip; } /* Since gtk_widget_measure does it for us, we can be sure here that * the given alloaction is large enough for the css margin/bordder/padding */ real_allocation.x = 0; real_allocation.y = 0; real_allocation.width -= margin.left + border.left + padding.left + margin.right + border.right + padding.right; real_allocation.height -= margin.top + border.top + padding.top + margin.bottom + border.bottom + padding.bottom; new_clip = real_allocation; if (g_signal_has_handler_pending (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, FALSE)) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, &real_allocation, baseline, &new_clip); else GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->size_allocate (widget, &real_allocation, baseline, &new_clip); /* Size allocation is god... after consulting god, no further requests or allocations are needed */ #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (GEOMETRY) && gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) { g_warning ("%s %p or a child called gtk_widget_queue_resize() during size_allocate().", gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); } #endif priv->reported_clip = new_clip; gtk_widget_set_clip (widget, &priv->reported_clip); *out_clip = priv->clip; gtk_widget_ensure_resize (widget); priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; priv->alloc_needed_on_child = FALSE; check_clip: size_changed |= (old_clip.width != priv->clip.width || old_clip.height != priv->clip.height); position_changed |= (old_clip.x != priv->clip.x || old_clip.y != priv->clip.y); if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { if (position_changed || size_changed || baseline_changed) { /* Invalidate union(old_clip,priv->clip) in the toplevel's window */ GtkWidget *parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->clip); cairo_region_union_rectangle (invalidate, &old_clip); /* Use the parent here since that's what priv->allocation and priv->clip * are relative to */ gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (parent ? parent : widget, invalidate); cairo_region_destroy (invalidate); } } out: if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (widget); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_common_ancestor: * @widget_a: a #GtkWidget * @widget_b: a #GtkWidget * * Find the common ancestor of @widget_a and @widget_b that * is closest to the two widgets. * * Returns: (nullable): the closest common ancestor of @widget_a and * @widget_b or %NULL if @widget_a and @widget_b do not * share a common ancestor. **/ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_common_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget_a, GtkWidget *widget_b) { GtkWidget *parent_a; GtkWidget *parent_b; gint depth_a = 0; gint depth_b = 0; parent_a = widget_a; while (parent_a->priv->parent) { parent_a = parent_a->priv->parent; depth_a++; } parent_b = widget_b; while (parent_b->priv->parent) { parent_b = parent_b->priv->parent; depth_b++; } if (parent_a != parent_b) return NULL; while (depth_a > depth_b) { widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; depth_a--; } while (depth_b > depth_a) { widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; depth_b--; } while (widget_a != widget_b) { widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; } return widget_a; } static void gtk_widget_get_origin_relative_to_parent (GtkWidget *widget, int *origin_x, int *origin_y) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder margin, border, padding; GtkCssStyle *style; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); /* allocation is relative to the parent's origin */ *origin_x = priv->allocation.x; *origin_y = priv->allocation.y; /* ... but points to the upper left, excluding widget margins * but including all the css properties */ *origin_x += margin.left + border.left + padding.left; *origin_y += margin.top + border.top + padding.top; } /** * gtk_widget_translate_coordinates: * @src_widget: a #GtkWidget * @dest_widget: a #GtkWidget * @src_x: X position relative to @src_widget * @src_y: Y position relative to @src_widget * @dest_x: (out) (optional): location to store X position relative to @dest_widget * @dest_y: (out) (optional): location to store Y position relative to @dest_widget * * Translate coordinates relative to @src_widget’s allocation to coordinates * relative to @dest_widget’s allocations. In order to perform this * operation, both widgets must be realized, and must share a common * toplevel. * * Returns: %FALSE if either widget was not realized, or there * was no common ancestor. In this case, nothing is stored in * *@dest_x and *@dest_y. Otherwise %TRUE. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (GtkWidget *src_widget, GtkWidget *dest_widget, gint src_x, gint src_y, gint *dest_x, gint *dest_y) { GtkWidget *ancestor; GtkWidget *parent; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (src_widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (dest_widget), FALSE); ancestor = gtk_widget_common_ancestor (src_widget, dest_widget); if (!ancestor || !_gtk_widget_get_realized (src_widget) || !_gtk_widget_get_realized (dest_widget)) return FALSE; parent = src_widget; while (parent != ancestor) { int origin_x, origin_y; gtk_widget_get_origin_relative_to_parent (parent, &origin_x, &origin_y); src_x += origin_x; src_y += origin_y; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } parent = dest_widget; while (parent != ancestor) { int origin_x, origin_y; gtk_widget_get_origin_relative_to_parent (parent, &origin_x, &origin_y); src_x -= origin_x; src_y -= origin_y; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } if (dest_x) *dest_x = src_x; if (dest_y) *dest_y = src_y; return TRUE; } static void gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *allocation, int baseline, GtkAllocation *out_clip) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { GtkAllocation window_alloc; gtk_widget_get_window_allocation (widget, &window_alloc); gdk_window_move_resize (priv->window, window_alloc.x, window_alloc.y, window_alloc.width, window_alloc.height); } } /* translate initial/final into start/end */ static GtkAlign effective_align (GtkAlign align, GtkTextDirection direction) { switch (align) { case GTK_ALIGN_START: return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_END : GTK_ALIGN_START; case GTK_ALIGN_END: return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_START : GTK_ALIGN_END; case GTK_ALIGN_FILL: case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER: case GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE: default: return align; } } static void adjust_for_align (GtkAlign align, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { switch (align) { case GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE: case GTK_ALIGN_FILL: default: /* change nothing */ break; case GTK_ALIGN_START: /* keep *allocated_pos where it is */ *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); break; case GTK_ALIGN_END: if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) { *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size); *allocated_size = *natural_size; } break; case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER: if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) { *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size) / 2; *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); } break; } } static void adjust_for_margin(gint start_margin, gint end_margin, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { *minimum_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); *natural_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); *allocated_pos += start_margin; *allocated_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); } void gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { adjust_for_margin (priv->margin.left, priv->margin.right, minimum_size, natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); adjust_for_align (effective_align (priv->halign, _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)), natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); } else { adjust_for_margin (priv->margin.top, priv->margin.bottom, minimum_size, natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); adjust_for_align (effective_align (priv->valign, GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE), natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); } } static void gtk_widget_adjust_baseline_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, gint *baseline) { *baseline -= widget->priv->margin.top; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; /* widgets must be onscreen for accels to take effect */ return gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && _gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget) && gdk_window_is_viewable (priv->window); } /** * gtk_widget_can_activate_accel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget * * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. * This is done by emitting the #GtkWidget::can-activate-accel * signal on @widget; if the signal isn’t overridden by a * handler or in a derived widget, then the default check is * that the widget must be sensitive, and the widget and all * its ancestors mapped. * * Returns: %TRUE if the accelerator can be activated. * * Since: 2.4 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { gboolean can_activate = FALSE; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL], 0, signal_id, &can_activate); return can_activate; } typedef struct { GClosure closure; guint signal_id; } AccelClosure; static void closure_accel_activate (GClosure *closure, GValue *return_value, guint n_param_values, const GValue *param_values, gpointer invocation_hint, gpointer marshal_data) { AccelClosure *aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; gboolean can_activate = gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id); if (can_activate) g_signal_emit (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id, 0); /* whether accelerator was handled */ g_value_set_boolean (return_value, can_activate); } static void closures_destroy (gpointer data) { GSList *slist, *closures = data; for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) { g_closure_invalidate (slist->data); g_closure_unref (slist->data); } g_slist_free (closures); } static GClosure* widget_new_accel_closure (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { AccelClosure *aclosure; GClosure *closure = NULL; GSList *slist, *closures; closures = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) if (!gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) { /* reuse this closure */ closure = slist->data; break; } if (!closure) { closure = g_closure_new_object (sizeof (AccelClosure), G_OBJECT (widget)); closures = g_slist_prepend (closures, g_closure_ref (closure)); g_closure_sink (closure); g_closure_set_marshal (closure, closure_accel_activate); } g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, closures, closures_destroy); aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; g_assert (closure->data == widget); g_assert (closure->marshal == closure_accel_activate); aclosure->signal_id = signal_id; return closure; } /** * gtk_widget_add_accelerator: * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on * @accel_signal: widget signal to emit on accelerator activation * @accel_group: accel group for this widget, added to its toplevel * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator * @accel_flags: flag accelerators, e.g. %GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE * * Installs an accelerator for this @widget in @accel_group that causes * @accel_signal to be emitted if the accelerator is activated. * The @accel_group needs to be added to the widget’s toplevel via * gtk_window_add_accel_group(), and the signal must be of type %G_SIGNAL_ACTION. * Accelerators added through this function are not user changeable during * runtime. If you want to support accelerators that can be changed by the * user, use gtk_accel_map_add_entry() and gtk_widget_set_accel_path() or * gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() instead. */ void gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *accel_signal, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, guint accel_key, GdkModifierType accel_mods, GtkAccelFlags accel_flags) { GClosure *closure; GSignalQuery query; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (accel_signal != NULL); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); g_signal_query (g_signal_lookup (accel_signal, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)), &query); if (!query.signal_id || !(query.signal_flags & G_SIGNAL_ACTION) || query.return_type != G_TYPE_NONE || query.n_params) { /* hmm, should be elaborate enough */ g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget '%s' has no activatable signal \"%s\" without arguments", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), accel_signal); return; } closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, query.signal_id); g_object_ref (widget); /* install the accelerator. since we don't map this onto an accel_path, * the accelerator will automatically be locked. */ gtk_accel_group_connect (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, accel_flags | GTK_ACCEL_LOCKED, closure); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_remove_accelerator: * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on * @accel_group: accel group for this widget * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator * * Removes an accelerator from @widget, previously installed with * gtk_widget_add_accelerator(). * * Returns: whether an accelerator was installed and could be removed */ gboolean gtk_widget_remove_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, guint accel_key, GdkModifierType accel_mods) { GtkAccelGroupEntry *ag_entry; GList *slist, *clist; guint n; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group), FALSE); ag_entry = gtk_accel_group_query (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, &n); clist = gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (widget); for (slist = clist; slist; slist = slist->next) { guint i; for (i = 0; i < n; i++) if (slist->data == (gpointer) ag_entry[i].closure) { gboolean is_removed = gtk_accel_group_disconnect (accel_group, slist->data); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); g_list_free (clist); return is_removed; } } g_list_free (clist); g_warning (G_STRLOC ": no accelerator (%u,%u) installed in accel group (%p) for %s (%p)", accel_key, accel_mods, accel_group, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_list_accel_closures: * @widget: widget to list accelerator closures for * * Lists the closures used by @widget for accelerator group connections * with gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path() or gtk_accel_group_connect(). * The closures can be used to monitor accelerator changes on @widget, * by connecting to the @GtkAccelGroup::accel-changed signal of the * #GtkAccelGroup of a closure which can be found out with * gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure(). * * Returns: (transfer container) (element-type GClosure): * a newly allocated #GList of closures */ GList* gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (GtkWidget *widget) { GSList *slist; GList *clist = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); for (slist = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); slist; slist = slist->next) if (gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) clist = g_list_prepend (clist, slist->data); return clist; } typedef struct { GQuark path_quark; GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; GClosure *closure; } AccelPath; static void destroy_accel_path (gpointer data) { AccelPath *apath = data; gtk_accel_group_disconnect (apath->accel_group, apath->closure); /* closures_destroy takes care of unrefing the closure */ g_object_unref (apath->accel_group); g_slice_free (AccelPath, apath); } /** * gtk_widget_set_accel_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @accel_path: (allow-none): path used to look up the accelerator * @accel_group: (allow-none): a #GtkAccelGroup. * * Given an accelerator group, @accel_group, and an accelerator path, * @accel_path, sets up an accelerator in @accel_group so whenever the * key binding that is defined for @accel_path is pressed, @widget * will be activated. This removes any accelerators (for any * accelerator group) installed by previous calls to * gtk_widget_set_accel_path(). Associating accelerators with * paths allows them to be modified by the user and the modifications * to be saved for future use. (See gtk_accel_map_save().) * * This function is a low level function that would most likely * be used by a menu creation system. * * If you only want to * set up accelerators on menu items gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() * provides a somewhat more convenient interface. * * Note that @accel_path string will be stored in a #GQuark. Therefore, if you * pass a static string, you can save some memory by interning it first with * g_intern_static_string(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *accel_path, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group) { AccelPath *apath; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal != 0); if (accel_path) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_accel_path_is_valid (accel_path)); gtk_accel_map_add_entry (accel_path, 0, 0); apath = g_slice_new (AccelPath); apath->accel_group = g_object_ref (accel_group); apath->path_quark = g_quark_from_string (accel_path); apath->closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal); } else apath = NULL; /* also removes possible old settings */ g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, apath, destroy_accel_path); if (apath) gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path (apath->accel_group, g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark), apath->closure); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); } const gchar* _gtk_widget_get_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean *locked) { AccelPath *apath; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); apath = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path); if (locked) *locked = apath ? gtk_accel_group_get_is_locked (apath->accel_group) : TRUE; return apath ? g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark) : NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @group_cycling: %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic * * Emits the #GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate signal. * * Returns: %TRUE if the signal has been handled */ gboolean gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling) { gboolean handled; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); group_cycling = group_cycling != FALSE; if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) handled = TRUE; else g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE], 0, group_cycling, &handled); return handled; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling) { if (!group_cycling && GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) gtk_widget_activate (widget); else if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); else { g_warning ("widget '%s' isn't suitable for mnemonic activation", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); } return TRUE; } static GskRenderer * gtk_widget_get_renderer (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) return gtk_window_get_renderer (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); return NULL; } typedef enum { RENDER_SNAPSHOT, RENDER_DRAW } RenderMode; static RenderMode get_render_mode (GtkWidgetClass *klass) { GtkWidgetClass *parent_class; for (parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass); parent_class != gtk_widget_parent_class; parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass)) { if (klass->snapshot != parent_class->snapshot) return RENDER_SNAPSHOT; else if (klass->draw != parent_class->draw) return RENDER_DRAW; klass = parent_class; } return RENDER_SNAPSHOT; } static void gtk_widget_draw_internal (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_t *cr) { if (!_gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) return; cairo_rectangle (cr, widget->priv->clip.x - widget->priv->allocation.x, widget->priv->clip.y - widget->priv->allocation.y, widget->priv->clip.width, widget->priv->clip.height); cairo_clip (cr); if (gdk_cairo_get_clip_rectangle (cr, NULL)) { GtkWidgetClass *widget_class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); GdkWindow *event_window = NULL; gboolean result; RenderMode mode; #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS if (_gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (widget)) g_warning ("%s %p is drawn without a current allocation. This should not happen.", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); #endif /* If the widget uses GSK render nodes then we need a fallback path to * render on the Cairo context; otherwise we just go through the old * GtkWidget::draw path */ mode = get_render_mode (widget_class); if (mode == RENDER_SNAPSHOT) { GskRenderer *renderer = gtk_widget_get_renderer (widget); GtkSnapshot snapshot; cairo_region_t *clip; GskRenderNode *node; clip = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&(cairo_rectangle_int_t) { widget->priv->clip.x - widget->priv->allocation.x, widget->priv->clip.y - widget->priv->allocation.y, widget->priv->clip.width, widget->priv->clip.height}); gtk_snapshot_init (&snapshot, renderer, FALSE, clip, "Fallback<%s>", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); gtk_widget_snapshot (widget, &snapshot); node = gtk_snapshot_finish (&snapshot); if (node != NULL) { gsk_render_node_draw (node, cr); gsk_render_node_unref (node); } cairo_region_destroy (clip); } else { gboolean push_group = widget->priv->alpha != 255 && !_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget); if (push_group) cairo_push_group (cr); if (g_signal_has_handler_pending (widget, widget_signals[DRAW], 0, FALSE)) { g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DRAW], 0, cr, &result); } else if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->draw) { cairo_save (cr); GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->draw (widget, cr); cairo_restore (cr); } if (push_group) { cairo_pop_group_to_source (cr); cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_OVER); cairo_paint_with_alpha (cr, widget->priv->alpha / 255.0); } } #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (gtk_widget_get_display (widget), BASELINES)) { gint baseline = gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline (widget); gint width = gtk_widget_get_allocated_width (widget); if (baseline != -1) { cairo_save (cr); cairo_new_path (cr); cairo_move_to (cr, 0, baseline+0.5); cairo_line_to (cr, width, baseline+0.5); cairo_set_line_width (cr, 1.0); cairo_set_source_rgba (cr, 1.0, 0, 0, 0.25); cairo_stroke (cr); cairo_restore (cr); } } if (widget->priv->highlight_resize) { GtkAllocation alloc; gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &alloc); cairo_rectangle (cr, 0, 0, alloc.width, alloc.height); cairo_set_source_rgba (cr, 1, 0, 0, 0.2); cairo_fill (cr); gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); widget->priv->highlight_resize = FALSE; } #endif if (cairo_status (cr) && event_window != NULL) { /* We check the event so we only warn about internal GTK+ calls. * Errors might come from PDF streams having write failures and * we don't want to spam stderr in that case. * We do want to catch errors from */ g_warning ("drawing failure for widget '%s': %s", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), cairo_status_to_string (cairo_status (cr))); } } } /** * gtk_widget_draw: * @widget: the widget to draw. It must be drawable (see * gtk_widget_is_drawable()) and a size must have been allocated. * @cr: a cairo context to draw to * * Draws @widget to @cr. The top left corner of the widget will be * drawn to the currently set origin point of @cr. * * You should pass a cairo context as @cr argument that is in an * original state. Otherwise the resulting drawing is undefined. For * example changing the operator using cairo_set_operator() or the * line width using cairo_set_line_width() might have unwanted side * effects. * You may however change the context’s transform matrix - like with * cairo_scale(), cairo_translate() or cairo_set_matrix() and clip * region with cairo_clip() prior to calling this function. Also, it * is fine to modify the context with cairo_save() and * cairo_push_group() prior to calling this function. * * Note that special-purpose widgets may contain special code for * rendering to the screen and might appear differently on screen * and when rendered using gtk_widget_draw(). * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_draw (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_t *cr) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!widget->priv->alloc_needed); g_return_if_fail (!widget->priv->alloc_needed_on_child); g_return_if_fail (cr != NULL); cairo_save (cr); gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr); cairo_restore (cr); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_button_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event) { return GDK_EVENT_PROPAGATE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_motion_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event) { return GDK_EVENT_PROPAGATE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_press_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event) { return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_release_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event) { return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event) { gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); return FALSE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event) { gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); return FALSE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_touch_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventTouch *event) { return GDK_EVENT_PROPAGATE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_grab_broken_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventGrabBroken *event) { return GDK_EVENT_PROPAGATE; } #define WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT(widget, event) \ (event->any.type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE || _gtk_widget_get_realized(widget)) /** * gtk_widget_event: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @event: a #GdkEvent * * Rarely-used function. This function is used to emit * the event signals on a widget (those signals should never * be emitted without using this function to do so). * If you want to synthesize an event though, don’t use this function; * instead, use gtk_main_do_event() so the event will behave as if * it were in the event queue. Don’t synthesize expose events; instead, * use gtk_widget_queue_draw_region() to invalidate a region of the * window. * * Returns: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if * the event was handled) **/ gboolean gtk_widget_event (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE); if (event->any.type == GDK_EXPOSE) { g_warning ("Events of type GDK_EXPOSE cannot be synthesized. To get " "the same effect, call gdk_window_invalidate_rect/region(), " "followed by gdk_window_process_updates()."); return TRUE; } return gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); } void _gtk_widget_set_captured_event_handler (GtkWidget *widget, GtkCapturedEventHandler callback) { g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), I_("captured-event-handler"), callback); } static gboolean _gtk_widget_run_controllers (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event, GtkPropagationPhase phase) { EventControllerData *data; gboolean handled = FALSE; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GList *l; priv = widget->priv; g_object_ref (widget); l = priv->event_controllers; while (l != NULL) { GList *next = l->next; if (!WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event)) break; data = l->data; if (data->controller == NULL) { priv->event_controllers = g_list_delete_link (priv->event_controllers, l); g_free (data); } else { GtkPropagationPhase controller_phase; controller_phase = gtk_event_controller_get_propagation_phase (data->controller); if (controller_phase == phase) handled |= gtk_event_controller_handle_event (data->controller, event); } l = next; } g_object_unref (widget); return handled; } static void cancel_event_sequence_on_hierarchy (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *event_widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence) { gboolean cancel = TRUE; while (event_widget) { if (event_widget == widget) cancel = FALSE; else if (cancel) _gtk_widget_cancel_sequence (event_widget, sequence); else _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (event_widget, sequence, GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED, NULL); event_widget = _gtk_widget_get_parent (event_widget); } } static void translate_event_coordinates (GdkEvent *event, GtkWidget *widget); gboolean _gtk_widget_captured_event (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event) { gboolean return_val = FALSE; GtkCapturedEventHandler handler; GdkEvent *event_copy; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE); if (event->any.type == GDK_EXPOSE) { g_warning ("Events of type GDK_EXPOSE cannot be synthesized. To get " "the same effect, call gdk_window_invalidate_rect/region(), " "followed by gdk_window_process_updates()."); return TRUE; } if (!event_window_is_still_viewable (event)) return TRUE; event_copy = gdk_event_copy (event); translate_event_coordinates (event_copy, widget); return_val = _gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_CAPTURE); handler = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), I_("captured-event-handler")); if (!handler) goto out; g_object_ref (widget); return_val |= handler (widget, event_copy); return_val |= !WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event_copy); g_object_unref (widget); out: g_object_unref (event_copy); return return_val; } static gboolean event_window_is_still_viewable (const GdkEvent *event) { /* Check that we think the event's window is viewable before * delivering the event, to prevent surprises. We do this here * at the last moment, since the event may have been queued * up behind other events, held over a recursive main loop, etc. */ switch ((guint) event->any.type) { case GDK_EXPOSE: case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY: case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_KEY_PRESS: case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY: case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN: case GDK_SCROLL: return event->any.window && gdk_window_is_viewable (event->any.window); #if 0 /* The following events are the second half of paired events; * we always deliver them to deal with widgets that clean up * on the second half. */ case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE: case GDK_KEY_RELEASE: case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY: case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT: #endif default: /* Remaining events would make sense on an not-viewable window, * or don't have an associated window. */ return TRUE; } } static void translate_event_coordinates (GdkEvent *event, GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *event_widget; double x, y; int dx, dy; if (!gdk_event_get_coords (event, &x, &y)) return; event_widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event); gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (event_widget, widget, x, y, &dx, &dy); gdk_event_set_coords (event, dx, dy); } static gint gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event) { gboolean return_val = FALSE; GdkEvent *event_copy; /* We check only once for is-still-visible; if someone * hides the window in on of the signals on the widget, * they are responsible for returning TRUE to terminate * handling. */ if (!event_window_is_still_viewable (event)) return TRUE; /* Non input events get handled right away */ switch ((guint) event->any.type) { case GDK_EXPOSE: case GDK_NOTHING: case GDK_DELETE: case GDK_DESTROY: case GDK_CONFIGURE: case GDK_MAP: case GDK_UNMAP: case GDK_WINDOW_STATE: case GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY: return gtk_widget_emit_event_signals (widget, event); default: break; } event_copy = gdk_event_copy (event); translate_event_coordinates (event_copy, widget); if (widget == gtk_get_event_target (event_copy)) return_val |= _gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_TARGET); /* XXX: Tooltips should be handled through captured events in the toplevel */ if (event_copy->any.type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE) { if (event_copy->focus_change.in) _gtk_tooltip_focus_in (widget); else _gtk_tooltip_focus_out (widget); } if (return_val == FALSE) return_val |= _gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_BUBBLE); g_object_unref (event_copy); return return_val; } gboolean gtk_widget_emit_event_signals (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkEvent *event) { gboolean return_val = FALSE, handled; g_object_ref (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT], 0, event, &handled); return_val |= handled | !WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event); if (!return_val) { gint signal_num; switch (event->any.type) { case GDK_DRAG_ENTER: case GDK_DRAG_LEAVE: case GDK_DRAG_MOTION: case GDK_DRAG_STATUS: case GDK_DROP_START: case GDK_DROP_FINISHED: case GDK_CLIENT_EVENT: case GDK_DAMAGE: case GDK_EVENT_LAST: case GDK_TOUCHPAD_SWIPE: case GDK_TOUCHPAD_PINCH: case GDK_PAD_BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_PAD_BUTTON_RELEASE: case GDK_PAD_RING: case GDK_PAD_STRIP: case GDK_PAD_GROUP_MODE: case GDK_EXPOSE: case GDK_NOTHING: signal_num = -1; break; case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS: signal_num = BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT; break; case GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN: case GDK_TOUCH_UPDATE: case GDK_TOUCH_END: case GDK_TOUCH_CANCEL: signal_num = TOUCH_EVENT; break; case GDK_SCROLL: signal_num = SCROLL_EVENT; break; case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE: signal_num = BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT; break; case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY: signal_num = MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_DELETE: signal_num = DELETE_EVENT; break; case GDK_DESTROY: signal_num = DESTROY_EVENT; _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); break; case GDK_KEY_PRESS: signal_num = KEY_PRESS_EVENT; break; case GDK_KEY_RELEASE: signal_num = KEY_RELEASE_EVENT; break; case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY: signal_num = ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY: signal_num = LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE: signal_num = event->focus_change.in ? FOCUS_IN_EVENT : FOCUS_OUT_EVENT; break; case GDK_CONFIGURE: signal_num = CONFIGURE_EVENT; break; case GDK_MAP: signal_num = MAP_EVENT; break; case GDK_UNMAP: signal_num = UNMAP_EVENT; break; case GDK_WINDOW_STATE: signal_num = WINDOW_STATE_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY: signal_num = PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN: signal_num = PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT: signal_num = PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT; break; case GDK_GRAB_BROKEN: signal_num = GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT; break; default: g_warning ("gtk_widget_event(): unhandled event type: %d", event->any.type); signal_num = -1; break; } if (signal_num != -1) { g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[signal_num], 0, event, &handled); return_val |= handled; } } if (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event)) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER], 0, event); else return_val = TRUE; g_object_unref (widget); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_activate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget that’s activatable * * For widgets that can be “activated” (buttons, menu items, etc.) * this function activates them. Activation is what happens when you * press Enter on a widget during key navigation. If @widget isn't * activatable, the function returns %FALSE. * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget was activatable **/ gboolean gtk_widget_activate (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) { /* FIXME: we should eventually check the signals signature here */ g_signal_emit (widget, WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal, 0); return TRUE; } else return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_intersect: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @area: a rectangle * @intersection: (out caller-allocates) (optional): rectangle to store * intersection of @widget and @area * * Computes the intersection of a @widget’s area and @area, storing * the intersection in @intersection, and returns %TRUE if there was * an intersection. @intersection may be %NULL if you’re only * interested in whether there was an intersection. * * Returns: %TRUE if there was an intersection **/ gboolean gtk_widget_intersect (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkRectangle *area, GdkRectangle *intersection) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GdkRectangle *dest; GdkRectangle tmp; gint return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (area != NULL, FALSE); priv = widget->priv; if (intersection) dest = intersection; else dest = &tmp; return_val = gdk_rectangle_intersect (&priv->allocation, area, dest); if (return_val && intersection && _gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { intersection->x -= priv->allocation.x; intersection->y -= priv->allocation.y; } return return_val; } /** * _gtk_widget_grab_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @was_grabbed: whether a grab is now in effect * * Emits the #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal on @widget. * * Since: 2.6 **/ void _gtk_widget_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean was_grabbed) { g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY], 0, was_grabbed); } /** * gtk_widget_grab_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Causes @widget to have the keyboard focus for the #GtkWindow it's * inside. @widget must be a focusable widget, such as a #GtkEntry; * something like #GtkFrame won’t work. * * More precisely, it must have the %GTK_CAN_FOCUS flag set. Use * gtk_widget_set_can_focus() to modify that flag. * * The widget also needs to be realized and mapped. This is indicated by the * related signals. Grabbing the focus immediately after creating the widget * will likely fail and cause critical warnings. **/ void gtk_widget_grab_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) return; g_object_ref (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS], 0); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HAS_FOCUS]); g_object_unref (widget); } static void reset_focus_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) { gtk_widget_set_focus_child (widget, NULL); gtk_widget_forall (widget, reset_focus_recurse, NULL); } static void gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; GtkWidget *widget; /* clear the current focus setting, break if the current widget * is the focus widget's parent, since containers above that will * be set by the next loop. */ toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (focus_widget); if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel) && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) { widget = gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); if (widget == focus_widget) { /* We call _gtk_window_internal_set_focus() here so that the * toplevel window can request the focus if necessary. * This is needed when the toplevel is a GtkPlug */ if (!gtk_widget_has_focus (widget)) _gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), focus_widget); return; } if (widget) { GtkWidget *common_ancestor = gtk_widget_common_ancestor (widget, focus_widget); if (widget != common_ancestor) { while (widget->priv->parent) { widget = widget->priv->parent; gtk_widget_set_focus_child (widget, NULL); if (widget == common_ancestor) break; } } } } else if (toplevel != focus_widget) { /* gtk_widget_grab_focus() operates on a tree without window... * actually, this is very questionable behavior. */ gtk_widget_forall (toplevel, reset_focus_recurse, NULL); } /* now propagate the new focus up the widget tree and finally * set it on the window */ widget = focus_widget; while (widget->priv->parent) { gtk_widget_set_focus_child (widget->priv->parent, widget); widget = widget->priv->parent; } if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) _gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (widget), focus_widget); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gboolean keyboard_tip, GtkTooltip *tooltip) { gchar *tooltip_markup; gboolean has_tooltip; tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); has_tooltip = gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (widget); if (has_tooltip && tooltip_markup) { gtk_tooltip_set_markup (tooltip, tooltip_markup); return TRUE; } return FALSE; } gboolean gtk_widget_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gboolean keyboard_mode, GtkTooltip *tooltip) { gboolean retval = FALSE; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP], 0, x, y, keyboard_mode, tooltip, &retval); return retval; } static void gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags old_state) { } static void gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget) { gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); if (widget->priv->context) { GtkCssStyleChange *change = gtk_style_context_get_change (widget->priv->context); const gboolean has_text = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget) != NULL; if (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT)) gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); if (widget->priv->anchored) { if (change == NULL || gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_SIZE) || (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT_SIZE))) { gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } else if (gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_CLIP) || (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT_CLIP))) { gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); } else if (gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_REDRAW)) { gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); } } } else { gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); if (widget->priv->anchored) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) { if (!gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)) { gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); return TRUE; } } else if (_gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget) == NULL) { /* No children, no possibility to focus anything */ return FALSE; } else { GPtrArray *focus_order = g_ptr_array_new (); gboolean ret = FALSE; /* Try focusing any of the child widgets, depending on the given @direction */ gtk_widget_focus_sort (widget, direction, focus_order); ret = gtk_widget_focus_move (widget, direction, focus_order); g_ptr_array_unref (focus_order); if (ret) return TRUE; } return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (widget != toplevel && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) { g_signal_emit (toplevel, widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS], 0, direction); } } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { switch (direction) { case GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD: case GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD: return FALSE; case GTK_DIR_UP: case GTK_DIR_DOWN: case GTK_DIR_LEFT: case GTK_DIR_RIGHT: default: break; } gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); return TRUE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_can_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @can_focus: whether or not @widget can own the input focus. * * Specifies whether @widget can own the input focus. See * gtk_widget_grab_focus() for actually setting the input focus on a * widget. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean can_focus) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->can_focus != can_focus) { widget->priv->can_focus = can_focus; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CAN_FOCUS]); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_can_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can own the input focus. See * gtk_widget_set_can_focus(). * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget can own the input focus, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->can_focus; } /** * gtk_widget_has_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget has the global input focus. See * gtk_widget_is_focus() for the difference between having the global * input focus, and only having the focus within a toplevel. * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget has the global input focus. * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_focus; } /** * gtk_widget_has_visible_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget should show a visible indication that * it has the global input focus. This is a convenience function for * use in ::draw handlers that takes into account whether focus * indication should currently be shown in the toplevel window of * @widget. See gtk_window_get_focus_visible() for more information * about focus indication. * * To find out if the widget has the global input focus, use * gtk_widget_has_focus(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget should display a “focus rectangle” * * Since: 3.2 */ gboolean gtk_widget_has_visible_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { gboolean draw_focus; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (widget->priv->has_focus) { GtkWidget *toplevel; toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) draw_focus = gtk_window_get_focus_visible (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else draw_focus = TRUE; } else draw_focus = FALSE; return draw_focus; } /** * gtk_widget_is_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget is the focus widget within its * toplevel. (This does not mean that the #GtkWidget:has-focus property is * necessarily set; #GtkWidget:has-focus will only be set if the * toplevel widget additionally has the global input focus.) * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is the focus widget. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) return widget == gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @focus_on_click: whether the widget should grab focus when clicked with the mouse * * Sets whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. * Making mouse clicks not grab focus is useful in places like toolbars where * you don’t want the keyboard focus removed from the main area of the * application. * * Since: 3.20 **/ void gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean focus_on_click) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; focus_on_click = focus_on_click != FALSE; if (priv->focus_on_click != focus_on_click) { priv->focus_on_click = focus_on_click; g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK]); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. * See gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with * the mouse. * * Since: 3.20 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->focus_on_click; } /** * gtk_widget_set_can_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @can_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget. * * Specifies whether @widget can be a default widget. See * gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of * “default”. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_can_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean can_default) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->can_default != can_default) { widget->priv->can_default = can_default; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CAN_DEFAULT]); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_can_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can be a default widget. See * gtk_widget_set_can_default(). * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget can be a default widget, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_can_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->can_default; } /** * gtk_widget_has_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is the current default widget within its * toplevel. See gtk_widget_set_can_default(). * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is the current default widget within * its toplevel, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_has_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_default; } void _gtk_widget_set_has_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_default) { GtkStyleContext *context; widget->priv->has_default = has_default; context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); if (has_default) gtk_style_context_add_class (context, GTK_STYLE_CLASS_DEFAULT); else gtk_style_context_remove_class (context, GTK_STYLE_CLASS_DEFAULT); } /** * gtk_widget_grab_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Causes @widget to become the default widget. @widget must be able to be * a default widget; typically you would ensure this yourself * by calling gtk_widget_set_can_default() with a %TRUE value. * The default widget is activated when * the user presses Enter in a window. Default widgets must be * activatable, that is, gtk_widget_activate() should affect them. Note * that #GtkEntry widgets require the “activates-default” property * set to %TRUE before they activate the default widget when Enter * is pressed and the #GtkEntry is focused. **/ void gtk_widget_grab_default (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *window; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget)); window = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (window && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window)) gtk_window_set_default (GTK_WINDOW (window), widget); else g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget not within a GtkWindow"); } /** * gtk_widget_set_receives_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @receives_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget. * * Specifies whether @widget will be treated as the default widget * within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget * is the default. * * See gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of * “default”. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean receives_default) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->receives_default != receives_default) { widget->priv->receives_default = receives_default; g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT]); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_receives_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is always treated as the default widget * within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget * is the default. * * See gtk_widget_set_receives_default(). * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget acts as the default widget when focused, * %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->receives_default; } /** * gtk_widget_has_grab: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget is currently grabbing events, so it * is the only widget receiving input events (keyboard and mouse). * * See also gtk_grab_add(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is in the grab_widgets stack * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_grab; } void _gtk_widget_set_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_grab) { widget->priv->has_grab = has_grab; } /** * gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Returns %TRUE if @device has been shadowed by a GTK+ * device grab on another widget, so it would stop sending * events to @widget. This may be used in the * #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal to check for specific * devices. See gtk_device_grab_add(). * * Returns: %TRUE if there is an ongoing grab on @device * by another #GtkWidget than @widget. * * Since: 3.0 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GtkWindowGroup *group; GtkWidget *grab_widget, *toplevel; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE); if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return TRUE; toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) group = gtk_window_get_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else group = gtk_window_get_group (NULL); grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_device_grab (group, device); /* Widget not inside the hierarchy of grab_widget */ if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget && !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) return TRUE; grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_grab (group); if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget && !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) return TRUE; return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @name: name for the widget * * Widgets can be named, which allows you to refer to them from a * CSS file. You can apply a style to widgets with a particular name * in the CSS file. See the documentation for the CSS syntax (on the * same page as the docs for #GtkStyleContext). * * Note that the CSS syntax has certain special characters to delimit * and represent elements in a selector (period, #, >, *...), so using * these will make your widget impossible to match by name. Any combination * of alphanumeric symbols, dashes and underscores will suffice. */ void gtk_widget_set_name (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *name) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; gchar *new_name; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; new_name = g_strdup (name); g_free (priv->name); priv->name = new_name; if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_id (priv->context, priv->name); gtk_css_node_set_id (priv->cssnode, priv->name); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_NAME]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Retrieves the name of a widget. See gtk_widget_set_name() for the * significance of widget names. * * Returns: name of the widget. This string is owned by GTK+ and * should not be modified or freed **/ const gchar* gtk_widget_get_name (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->name) return priv->name; return G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget); } static void gtk_widget_update_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags_to_set, GtkStateFlags flags_to_unset) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; priv = widget->priv; /* Handle insensitive first, since it is propagated * differently throughout the widget hierarchy. */ if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags_to_unset & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE); else if (!(priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags_to_set & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, FALSE); flags_to_set &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); flags_to_unset &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); if (flags_to_set != 0 || flags_to_unset != 0) { GtkStateData data; data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); data.flags_to_set = flags_to_set; data.flags_to_unset = flags_to_unset; gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @flags: State flags to turn on * @clear: Whether to clear state before turning on @flags * * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns on flag * values in the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). * * This function accepts the values %GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR and * %GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL but ignores them. If you want to set the widget's * direction, use gtk_widget_set_direction(). * * It is worth mentioning that any other state than %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE, * will be propagated down to all non-internal children if @widget is a * #GtkContainer, while %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE itself will be propagated * down to all #GtkContainer children by different means than turning on the * state flag down the hierarchy, both gtk_widget_get_state_flags() and * gtk_widget_is_sensitive() will make use of these. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_set_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags, gboolean clear) { #define ALLOWED_FLAGS (~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR | GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL)) g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if ((!clear && (widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == flags) || (clear && widget->priv->state_flags == flags)) return; if (clear) gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS, ~flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS); else gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS, 0); #undef ALLOWED_FLAGS } /** * gtk_widget_unset_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @flags: State flags to turn off * * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns off flag * values for the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). * See gtk_widget_set_state_flags(). * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if ((widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == 0) return; gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, 0, flags); } /** * gtk_widget_get_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget state as a flag set. It is worth mentioning * that the effective %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE state will be * returned, that is, also based on parent insensitivity, even if * @widget itself is sensitive. * * Also note that if you are looking for a way to obtain the * #GtkStateFlags to pass to a #GtkStyleContext method, you * should look at gtk_style_context_get_state(). * * Returns: The state flags for widget * * Since: 3.0 **/ GtkStateFlags gtk_widget_get_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->state_flags; } /** * gtk_widget_set_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @visible: whether the widget should be shown or not * * Sets the visibility state of @widget. Note that setting this to * %TRUE doesn’t mean the widget is actually viewable, see * gtk_widget_get_visible(). * * This function simply calls gtk_widget_show() or gtk_widget_hide() * but is nicer to use when the visibility of the widget depends on * some condition. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_visible (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean visible) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (visible) gtk_widget_show (widget); else gtk_widget_hide (widget); } void _gtk_widget_set_visible_flag (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean visible) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; priv->visible = visible; if (!visible) { priv->allocation.x = -1; priv->allocation.y = -1; priv->allocation.width = 0; priv->allocation.height = 0; memset (&priv->clip, 0, sizeof (priv->clip)); memset (&priv->allocated_size, 0, sizeof (priv->allocated_size)); priv->allocated_size_baseline = 0; } } /** * gtk_widget_get_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget is visible. If you want to * take into account whether the widget’s parent is also marked as * visible, use gtk_widget_is_visible() instead. * * This function does not check if the widget is obscured in any way. * * See gtk_widget_set_visible(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is visible * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_visible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->visible; } /** * gtk_widget_is_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget and all its parents are marked as * visible. * * This function does not check if the widget is obscured in any way. * * See also gtk_widget_get_visible() and gtk_widget_set_visible() * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget and all its parents are visible * * Since: 3.8 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_visible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); while (widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!priv->visible) return FALSE; widget = priv->parent; } return TRUE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_has_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @has_window: whether or not @widget has a window. * * Specifies whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. Note that * all realized widgets have a non-%NULL “window” pointer * (gtk_widget_get_window() never returns a %NULL window when a widget * is realized), but for many of them it’s actually the #GdkWindow of * one of its parent widgets. Widgets that do not create a %window for * themselves in #GtkWidget::realize must announce this by * calling this function with @has_window = %FALSE. * * This function should only be called by widget implementations, * and they should call it in their init() function. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_has_window (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_window) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->no_window = !has_window; widget->priv->no_window_set = TRUE; /* GdkWindow has a min size of 1×1 */ widget->priv->allocation.width = 1; widget->priv->allocation.height = 1; } /** * gtk_widget_get_has_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. See * gtk_widget_set_has_window(). * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget has a window, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_has_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return ! widget->priv->no_window; } /** * gtk_widget_is_toplevel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is a toplevel widget. * * Currently only #GtkWindow and #GtkInvisible are toplevel widgets. * Toplevel widgets have no parent widget. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is a toplevel, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->toplevel; } void _gtk_widget_set_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean is_toplevel) { widget->priv->toplevel = is_toplevel; } /** * gtk_widget_is_drawable: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can be drawn to. A widget can be drawn * to if it is mapped and visible. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is drawable, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_drawable (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_realized: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is realized. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is realized, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.20 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_realized (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->realized; } /** * gtk_widget_set_realized: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @realized: %TRUE to mark the widget as realized * * Marks the widget as being realized. This function must only be * called after all #GdkWindows for the @widget have been created * and registered. * * This function should only ever be called in a derived widget's * “realize” or “unrealize” implementation. * * Since: 2.20 */ void gtk_widget_set_realized (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean realized) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->realized = realized; } /** * gtk_widget_get_mapped: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Whether the widget is mapped. * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is mapped, %FALSE otherwise. * * Since: 2.20 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_mapped (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->mapped; } /** * gtk_widget_set_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @sensitive: %TRUE to make the widget sensitive * * Sets the sensitivity of a widget. A widget is sensitive if the user * can interact with it. Insensitive widgets are “grayed out” and the * user can’t interact with them. Insensitive widgets are known as * “inactive”, “disabled”, or “ghosted” in some other toolkits. **/ void gtk_widget_set_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean sensitive) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; sensitive = (sensitive != FALSE); if (priv->sensitive == sensitive) return; priv->sensitive = sensitive; if (priv->parent == NULL || gtk_widget_is_sensitive (priv->parent)) { GtkStateData data; data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); if (sensitive) { data.flags_to_set = 0; data.flags_to_unset = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; } else { data.flags_to_set = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; data.flags_to_unset = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT | GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE; } gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); } g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_SENSITIVE]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget’s sensitivity (in the sense of returning * the value that has been set using gtk_widget_set_sensitive()). * * The effective sensitivity of a widget is however determined by both its * own and its parent widget’s sensitivity. See gtk_widget_is_sensitive(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is sensitive * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->sensitive; } /** * gtk_widget_is_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget’s effective sensitivity, which means * it is sensitive itself and also its parent widget is sensitive * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is effectively sensitive * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_is_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return !(widget->priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); } /* Insert @widget into the children list of @parent, * after @previous_child */ static void gtk_widget_reposition_after (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *parent, GtkWidget *previous_sibling) { GtkStateFlags parent_flags; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkWidget *prev_parent; GtkStateData data; prev_parent = priv->parent; if (priv->parent != NULL && priv->parent != parent) { g_warning ("Can't set a parent on widget which has a parent"); return; } if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { g_warning ("Can't set a parent on a toplevel widget"); return; } data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_attach_to_widget() */ g_object_ref_sink (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); priv->parent = parent; if (previous_sibling) { if (previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling) previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = widget; if (priv->prev_sibling) priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; if (priv->next_sibling) priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; if (parent->priv->first_child == widget) parent->priv->first_child = priv->next_sibling; if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; priv->prev_sibling = previous_sibling; priv->next_sibling = previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling; previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling = widget; if (parent->priv->last_child == previous_sibling) parent->priv->last_child = widget; else if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) parent->priv->last_child = priv->next_sibling; } else { /* Beginning */ if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) { parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; if (priv->prev_sibling) priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = NULL; } if (priv->prev_sibling) priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; if (priv->next_sibling) priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; priv->prev_sibling = NULL; priv->next_sibling = parent->priv->first_child; if (parent->priv->first_child) parent->priv->first_child->priv->prev_sibling = widget; parent->priv->first_child = widget; if (parent->priv->last_child == NULL) parent->priv->last_child = widget; } parent_flags = _gtk_widget_get_state_flags (parent); /* Merge both old state and current parent state, * making sure to only propagate the right states */ data.flags_to_set = parent_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE; data.flags_to_unset = 0; gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); if (gtk_css_node_get_parent (widget->priv->cssnode) == NULL) { gtk_css_node_insert_after (parent->priv->cssnode, priv->cssnode, previous_sibling ? previous_sibling->priv->cssnode : NULL); } if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, _gtk_widget_get_style_context (parent)); _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); if (priv->parent->priv->anchored && prev_parent == NULL) _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, NULL); if (prev_parent == NULL) g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_PARENT]); /* Enforce realized/mapped invariants */ if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_realize (widget); if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent) && _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { if (_gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_map (widget); gtk_widget_queue_resize (priv->parent); } /* child may cause parent's expand to change, if the child is * expanded. If child is not expanded, then it can't modify the * parent's expand. If the child becomes expanded later then it will * queue compute_expand then. This optimization plus defaulting * newly-constructed widgets to need_compute_expand=FALSE should * mean that initially building a widget tree doesn't have to keep * walking up setting need_compute_expand on parents over and over. * * We can't change a parent to need to expand unless we're visible. */ if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && (priv->need_compute_expand || priv->computed_hexpand || priv->computed_vexpand)) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent); } gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_set_parent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @parent: parent widget * * This function is useful only when implementing subclasses of * #GtkWidget. * Sets @parent as the parent widget of @widget, and takes care of * some details such as updating the state and style of the child * to reflect its new location and resizing the parent. The opposite * function is gtk_widget_unparent(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_parent (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *parent) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_parent (widget) == NULL); gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, parent, _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_parent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the parent widget of @widget. * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the parent widget of @widget, or %NULL **/ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_parent (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->parent; } static void gtk_widget_real_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection previous_direction) { gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } typedef struct { GtkWidget *previous_toplevel; GdkDisplay *previous_display; GdkDisplay *new_display; } HierarchyChangedInfo; static void do_display_change (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDisplay *old_display, GdkDisplay *new_display) { if (old_display != new_display) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (old_display) { PangoContext *context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); if (context) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, NULL); } _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); if (new_display && priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_display (priv->context, new_display); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DISPLAY_CHANGED], 0, old_display); } } static void gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data; gboolean new_anchored = _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) || (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored); if (priv->anchored != new_anchored) { g_object_ref (widget); priv->anchored = new_anchored; /* This can only happen with gtk_widget_reparent() */ if (priv->realized) { if (new_anchored) gtk_widget_connect_frame_clock (widget, gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget)); else gtk_widget_disconnect_frame_clock (widget, gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (info->previous_toplevel)); } g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED], 0, info->previous_toplevel); do_display_change (widget, info->previous_display, info->new_display); gtk_widget_forall (widget, gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse, client_data); g_object_unref (widget); } } /** * _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @previous_toplevel: Previous toplevel * * Propagates changes in the anchored state to a widget and all * children, unsetting or setting the %ANCHORED flag, and * emitting #GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed. **/ void _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *previous_toplevel) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; HierarchyChangedInfo info; info.previous_toplevel = previous_toplevel; info.previous_display = previous_toplevel ? gtk_widget_get_display (previous_toplevel) : NULL; if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) || (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored)) info.new_display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); else info.new_display = NULL; if (info.previous_display) g_object_ref (info.previous_display); if (previous_toplevel) g_object_ref (previous_toplevel); gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (widget, &info); if (previous_toplevel) g_object_unref (previous_toplevel); if (info.previous_display) g_object_unref (info.previous_display); } static void gtk_widget_propagate_display_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data; GtkWidget *child; g_object_ref (widget); do_display_change (widget, info->previous_display, info->new_display); for (child = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_propagate_display_changed_recurse (child, client_data); } g_object_unref (widget); } /** * _gtk_widget_propagate_display_changed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @previous_display: Previous display * * Propagates changes in the display for a widget to all * children, emitting #GtkWidget::display-changed. **/ void _gtk_widget_propagate_display_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDisplay *previous_display) { HierarchyChangedInfo info; info.previous_display = previous_display; info.new_display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); if (previous_display) g_object_ref (previous_display); gtk_widget_propagate_display_changed_recurse (widget, &info); if (previous_display) g_object_unref (previous_display); } static void reset_style_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) { gtk_css_node_invalidate (widget->priv->cssnode, GTK_CSS_CHANGE_ANY); gtk_widget_forall (widget, reset_style_recurse, user_data); } /** * gtk_widget_reset_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Updates the style context of @widget and all descendants * by updating its widget path. #GtkContainers may want * to use this on a child when reordering it in a way that a different * style might apply to it. See also gtk_container_get_path_for_child(). * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_reset_style (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL); g_list_foreach (widget->priv->attached_windows, (GFunc) reset_style_recurse, NULL); } #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS /* Verify invariants, see docs/widget_system.txt for notes on much of * this. Invariants may be temporarily broken while we’re in the * process of updating state, of course, so you can only * verify_invariants() after a given operation is complete. * Use push/pop_verify_invariants to help with that. */ static void gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0) return; parent = widget->priv->parent; if (widget->priv->mapped) { /* Mapped implies ... */ if (!widget->priv->realized) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (!widget->priv->visible) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not visible", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { if (!widget->priv->child_visible) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not child_visible", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } } else { /* Not mapped implies... */ #if 0 /* This check makes sense for normal toplevels, but for * something like a toplevel that is embedded within a clutter * state, mapping may depend on external factors. */ if (widget->priv->toplevel) { if (widget->priv->visible) g_warning ("%s %p toplevel is visible but not mapped", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } #endif } /* Parent related checks aren't possible if parent has * verifying_invariants_count > 0 because parent needs to recurse * children first before the invariants will hold. */ if (parent == NULL || parent->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) { if (parent && parent->priv->realized) { /* Parent realized implies... */ #if 0 /* This is in widget_system.txt but appears to fail * because there's no gtk_container_realize() that * realizes all children... instead we just lazily * wait for map to fix things up. */ if (!widget->priv->realized) g_warning ("%s %p is realized but child %s %p is not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); #endif } else if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { /* No parent or parent not realized on non-toplevel implies... */ if (widget->priv->realized) g_warning ("%s %p is not realized but child %s %p is realized", parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } if (parent && parent->priv->mapped && widget->priv->visible && widget->priv->child_visible) { /* Parent mapped and we are visible implies... */ if (!widget->priv->mapped) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible child %s %p is not mapped", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } else if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { /* No parent or parent not mapped on non-toplevel implies... */ if (widget->priv->mapped) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible=%d child_visible=%d parent %s %p mapped=%d", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, widget->priv->visible, widget->priv->child_visible, parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, parent ? parent->priv->mapped : FALSE); } } if (!widget->priv->realized) { /* Not realized implies... */ #if 0 /* widget_system.txt says these hold, but they don't. */ if (widget->priv->alloc_needed) g_warning ("%s %p alloc needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (widget->priv->width_request_needed) g_warning ("%s %p width request needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (widget->priv->height_request_needed) g_warning ("%s %p height request needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); #endif } } /* The point of this push/pop is that invariants may not hold while * we’re busy making changes. So we only check at the outermost call * on the call stack, after we finish updating everything. */ static void gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count += 1; } static void gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { /* We don't recurse further; this is a one-level check. */ gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); } static void gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { g_assert (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0); widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count -= 1; if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) { GtkWidget *child; gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); /* Check one level of children, because our * push_verify_invariants() will have prevented some of the * checks. This does not recurse because if recursion is * needed, it will happen naturally as each child has a * push/pop on that child. For example if we're recursively * mapping children, we'll push/pop on each child as we map * it. */ for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (child); } } } #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ static PangoContext * gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); } /** * gtk_widget_get_pango_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets a #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, font description, * and base direction for this widget. Unlike the context returned * by gtk_widget_create_pango_context(), this context is owned by * the widget (it can be used until the screen for the widget changes * or the widget is removed from its toplevel), and will be updated to * match any changes to the widget’s attributes. This can be tracked * by using the #GtkWidget::display-changed signal on the widget. * * Returns: (transfer none): the #PangoContext for the widget. **/ PangoContext * gtk_widget_get_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); if (!context) { context = gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GTK_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, context, g_object_unref); } return context; } static PangoFontMap * gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoFontMap *font_map; font_map = PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); if (font_map) return font_map; else if (widget->priv->parent) return gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (widget->priv->parent); else return pango_cairo_font_map_get_default (); } static void update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget, PangoContext *context) { PangoFontDescription *font_desc; GtkStyleContext *style_context; GtkSettings *settings; cairo_font_options_t *font_options; style_context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); gtk_style_context_get (style_context, "font", &font_desc, NULL); pango_context_set_font_description (context, font_desc); pango_font_description_free (font_desc); pango_context_set_base_dir (context, _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget) == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR ? PANGO_DIRECTION_LTR : PANGO_DIRECTION_RTL); pango_cairo_context_set_resolution (context, _gtk_css_number_value_get ( _gtk_style_context_peek_property (style_context, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_DPI), 100)); settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget); font_options = (cairo_font_options_t*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); if (settings && font_options) { cairo_font_options_t *options; options = cairo_font_options_copy (gtk_settings_get_font_options (settings)); cairo_font_options_merge (options, font_options); pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context, options); cairo_font_options_destroy (options); } else if (settings) { pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context, gtk_settings_get_font_options (settings)); } pango_context_set_font_map (context, gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (widget)); } static void gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoContext *context = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget); if (context) update_pango_context (widget, context); } /** * gtk_widget_set_font_options: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @options: (allow-none): a #cairo_font_options_t, or %NULL to unset any * previously set default font options. * * Sets the #cairo_font_options_t used for Pango rendering in this widget. * When not set, the default font options for the #GdkDisplay will be used. * * Since: 3.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_font_options (GtkWidget *widget, const cairo_font_options_t *options) { cairo_font_options_t *font_options; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); font_options = (cairo_font_options_t *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); if (font_options != options) { g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options, options ? cairo_font_options_copy (options) : NULL, (GDestroyNotify)cairo_font_options_destroy); gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_font_options: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the #cairo_font_options_t used for Pango rendering. When not set, * the defaults font options for the #GdkDisplay will be used. * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the #cairo_font_options_t or %NULL if not set * * Since: 3.18 **/ const cairo_font_options_t * gtk_widget_get_font_options (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return (cairo_font_options_t *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); } static void gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) { if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)) return; gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); gtk_widget_forall (widget, gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse, user_data); } /** * gtk_widget_set_font_map: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @font_map: (allow-none): a #PangoFontMap, or %NULL to unset any previously * set font map * * Sets the font map to use for Pango rendering. When not set, the widget * will inherit the font map from its parent. * * Since: 3.18 */ void gtk_widget_set_font_map (GtkWidget *widget, PangoFontMap *font_map) { PangoFontMap *map; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); map = PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); if (map == font_map) return; g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map, g_object_ref (font_map), g_object_unref); gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); gtk_widget_forall (widget, gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_font_map: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the font map that has been set with gtk_widget_set_font_map(). * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): A #PangoFontMap, or %NULL * * Since: 3.18 */ PangoFontMap * gtk_widget_get_font_map (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); } /** * gtk_widget_create_pango_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Creates a new #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, * font options, font description, and base direction for drawing * text for this widget. See also gtk_widget_get_pango_context(). * * Returns: (transfer full): the new #PangoContext **/ PangoContext * gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); context = pango_font_map_create_context (pango_cairo_font_map_get_default ()); update_pango_context (widget, context); pango_context_set_language (context, gtk_get_default_language ()); return context; } /** * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @text: (nullable): text to set on the layout (can be %NULL) * * Creates a new #PangoLayout with the appropriate font map, * font description, and base direction for drawing text for * this widget. * * If you keep a #PangoLayout created in this way around, you need * to re-create it when the widget #PangoContext is replaced. * This can be tracked by using the #GtkWidget::display-changed signal * on the widget. * * Returns: (transfer full): the new #PangoLayout **/ PangoLayout * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *text) { PangoLayout *layout; PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); context = gtk_widget_get_pango_context (widget); layout = pango_layout_new (context); if (text) pango_layout_set_text (layout, text, -1); return layout; } /** * gtk_widget_set_parent_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * @parent_window: the new parent window. * * Sets a non default parent window for @widget. * * For #GtkWindow classes, setting a @parent_window effects whether * the window is a toplevel window or can be embedded into other * widgets. * * For #GtkWindow classes, this needs to be called before the * window is realized. */ void gtk_widget_set_parent_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *parent_window) { GdkWindow *old_parent_window; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)); old_parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window); if (parent_window != old_parent_window) { g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window, parent_window); if (old_parent_window) g_object_unref (old_parent_window); if (parent_window) g_object_ref (parent_window); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_parent_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * * Gets @widget’s parent window, or %NULL if it does not have one. * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the parent window of @widget, or %NULL * if it does not have a parent window. **/ GdkWindow * gtk_widget_get_parent_window (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GdkWindow *parent_window; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window); return (parent_window != NULL) ? parent_window : (priv->parent != NULL) ? priv->parent->priv->window : NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_set_child_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @is_visible: if %TRUE, @widget should be mapped along with its parent. * * Sets whether @widget should be mapped along with its when its parent * is mapped and @widget has been shown with gtk_widget_show(). * * The child visibility can be set for widget before it is added to * a container with gtk_widget_set_parent(), to avoid mapping * children unnecessary before immediately unmapping them. However * it will be reset to its default state of %TRUE when the widget * is removed from a container. * * Note that changing the child visibility of a widget does not * queue a resize on the widget. Most of the time, the size of * a widget is computed from all visible children, whether or * not they are mapped. If this is not the case, the container * can queue a resize itself. * * This function is only useful for container implementations and * never should be called by an application. **/ void gtk_widget_set_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean is_visible) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)); priv = widget->priv; g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); if (is_visible) priv->child_visible = TRUE; else { GtkWidget *toplevel; priv->child_visible = FALSE; toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (toplevel != widget && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); } if (priv->parent && _gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) { if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && priv->child_visible && _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_map (widget); else gtk_widget_unmap (widget); } gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_child_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value set with gtk_widget_set_child_visible(). * If you feel a need to use this function, your code probably * needs reorganization. * * This function is only useful for container implementations and * never should be called by an application. * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is mapped with the parent. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->child_visible; } void _gtk_widget_scale_changed (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_SCALE_FACTOR]); gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback)_gtk_widget_scale_changed, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_scale_factor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Retrieves the internal scale factor that maps from window coordinates * to the actual device pixels. On traditional systems this is 1, on * high density outputs, it can be a higher value (typically 2). * * See gdk_window_get_scale_factor(). * * Returns: the scale factor for @widget * * Since: 3.10 */ gint gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; GdkDisplay *display; GdkMonitor *monitor; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 1); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return gdk_window_get_scale_factor (_gtk_widget_get_window (widget)); toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (toplevel && toplevel != widget) return gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (toplevel); /* else fall back to something that is more likely to be right than * just returning 1: */ display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); monitor = gdk_display_get_monitor (display, 0); return gdk_monitor_get_scale_factor (monitor); } /** * gtk_widget_get_display: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Get the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel window associated with * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow at the top. * * In general, you should only create display specific * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should * free those resources when the widget is unrealized. * * Returns: (transfer none): the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel for this widget. * * Since: 2.2 **/ GdkDisplay* gtk_widget_get_display (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) { if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) return gtk_window_get_display (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else if (GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (toplevel)) return gtk_invisible_get_display (GTK_INVISIBLE (widget)); } return gdk_display_get_default (); } /** * gtk_widget_child_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @direction: direction of focus movement * * This function is used by custom widget implementations; if you're * writing an app, you’d use gtk_widget_grab_focus() to move the focus * to a particular widget, and gtk_container_set_focus_chain() to * change the focus tab order. So you may want to investigate those * functions instead. * * gtk_widget_child_focus() is called by containers as the user moves * around the window using keyboard shortcuts. @direction indicates * what kind of motion is taking place (up, down, left, right, tab * forward, tab backward). gtk_widget_child_focus() emits the * #GtkWidget::focus signal; widgets override the default handler * for this signal in order to implement appropriate focus behavior. * * The default ::focus handler for a widget should return %TRUE if * moving in @direction left the focus on a focusable location inside * that widget, and %FALSE if moving in @direction moved the focus * outside the widget. If returning %TRUE, widgets normally * call gtk_widget_grab_focus() to place the focus accordingly; * if returning %FALSE, they don’t modify the current focus location. * * Returns: %TRUE if focus ended up inside @widget **/ gboolean gtk_widget_child_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { gboolean return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) return FALSE; /* Emit ::focus in any case, even if can-focus is FALSE, * since any widget might have child widgets that will take * focus */ g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[FOCUS], 0, direction, &return_val); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_keynav_failed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @direction: direction of focus movement * * This function should be called whenever keyboard navigation within * a single widget hits a boundary. The function emits the * #GtkWidget::keynav-failed signal on the widget and its return * value should be interpreted in a way similar to the return value of * gtk_widget_child_focus(): * * When %TRUE is returned, stay in the widget, the failed keyboard * navigation is OK and/or there is nowhere we can/should move the * focus to. * * When %FALSE is returned, the caller should continue with keyboard * navigation outside the widget, e.g. by calling * gtk_widget_child_focus() on the widget’s toplevel. * * The default ::keynav-failed handler returns %TRUE for * %GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD and %GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD. For the other * values of #GtkDirectionType it returns %FALSE. * * Whenever the default handler returns %TRUE, it also calls * gtk_widget_error_bell() to notify the user of the failed keyboard * navigation. * * A use case for providing an own implementation of ::keynav-failed * (either by connecting to it or by overriding it) would be a row of * #GtkEntry widgets where the user should be able to navigate the * entire row with the cursor keys, as e.g. known from user interfaces * that require entering license keys. * * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard * navigation attempt in its parent container(s). * * Since: 2.12 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { gboolean return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED], 0, direction, &return_val); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_error_bell: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Notifies the user about an input-related error on this widget. * If the #GtkSettings:gtk-error-bell setting is %TRUE, it calls * gdk_window_beep(), otherwise it does nothing. * * Note that the effect of gdk_window_beep() can be configured in many * ways, depending on the windowing backend and the desktop environment * or window manager that is used. * * Since: 2.12 **/ void gtk_widget_error_bell (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkSettings* settings; gboolean beep; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget); if (!settings) return; g_object_get (settings, "gtk-error-bell", &beep, NULL); if (beep && priv->window) gdk_window_beep (priv->window); } static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; gboolean changed = FALSE; g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); if (width > -2 && priv->width != width) { g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST]); priv->width = width; changed = TRUE; } if (height > -2 && priv->height != height) { g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST]); priv->height = height; changed = TRUE; } if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && changed) { gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_set_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @width: width @widget should request, or -1 to unset * @height: height @widget should request, or -1 to unset * * Sets the minimum size of a widget; that is, the widget’s size * request will be at least @width by @height. You can use this * function to force a widget to be larger than it normally would be. * * In most cases, gtk_window_set_default_size() is a better choice for * toplevel windows than this function; setting the default size will * still allow users to shrink the window. Setting the size request * will force them to leave the window at least as large as the size * request. When dealing with window sizes, * gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() can be a useful function as well. * * Note the inherent danger of setting any fixed size - themes, * translations into other languages, different fonts, and user action * can all change the appropriate size for a given widget. So, it's * basically impossible to hardcode a size that will always be * correct. * * The size request of a widget is the smallest size a widget can * accept while still functioning well and drawing itself correctly. * However in some strange cases a widget may be allocated less than * its requested size, and in many cases a widget may be allocated more * space than it requested. * * If the size request in a given direction is -1 (unset), then * the “natural” size request of the widget will be used instead. * * The size request set here does not include any margin from the * #GtkWidget properties margin-left, margin-right, margin-top, and * margin-bottom, but it does include pretty much all other padding * or border properties set by any subclass of #GtkWidget. **/ void gtk_widget_set_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (width >= -1); g_return_if_fail (height >= -1); gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height); } /** * gtk_widget_get_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @width: (out) (allow-none): return location for width, or %NULL * @height: (out) (allow-none): return location for height, or %NULL * * Gets the size request that was explicitly set for the widget using * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). A value of -1 stored in @width or * @height indicates that that dimension has not been set explicitly * and the natural requisition of the widget will be used instead. See * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). To get the size a widget will * actually request, call gtk_widget_measure() instead of * this function. **/ void gtk_widget_get_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, gint *width, gint *height) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (width) *width = widget->priv->width; if (height) *height = widget->priv->height; } /*< private > * gtk_widget_has_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns if the widget has a size request set (anything besides -1 for height * or width) */ gboolean gtk_widget_has_size_request (GtkWidget *widget) { return !(widget->priv->width == -1 && widget->priv->height == -1); } /** * gtk_widget_get_toplevel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function returns the topmost widget in the container hierarchy * @widget is a part of. If @widget has no parent widgets, it will be * returned as the topmost widget. No reference will be added to the * returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. * * Note the difference in behavior vs. gtk_widget_get_ancestor(); * `gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_WINDOW)` * would return * %NULL if @widget wasn’t inside a toplevel window, and if the * window was inside a #GtkWindow-derived widget which was in turn * inside the toplevel #GtkWindow. * * To reliably find the toplevel #GtkWindow, use * gtk_widget_get_toplevel() and call gtk_widget_is_toplevel() * on the result. * |[<!-- language="C" --> * GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); * if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) * { * // Perform action on toplevel. * } * ]| * * Returns: (transfer none): the topmost ancestor of @widget, or @widget itself * if there’s no ancestor. **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); while (widget->priv->parent) widget = widget->priv->parent; return widget; } /** * gtk_widget_get_ancestor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @widget_type: ancestor type * * Gets the first ancestor of @widget with type @widget_type. For example, * `gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX)` gets * the first #GtkBox that’s an ancestor of @widget. No reference will be * added to the returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. See note * about checking for a toplevel #GtkWindow in the docs for * gtk_widget_get_toplevel(). * * Note that unlike gtk_widget_is_ancestor(), gtk_widget_get_ancestor() * considers @widget to be an ancestor of itself. * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the ancestor widget, or %NULL if not found **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_get_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, GType widget_type) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); while (widget && !g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type)) widget = widget->priv->parent; if (!(widget && g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type))) return NULL; return widget; } /** * gtk_widget_get_settings: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the settings object holding the settings used for this widget. * * Note that this function can only be called when the #GtkWidget * is attached to a toplevel, since the settings object is specific * to a particular #GdkDisplay. * * Returns: (transfer none): the relevant #GtkSettings object */ GtkSettings* gtk_widget_get_settings (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gtk_settings_get_for_display (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_is_ancestor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @ancestor: another #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is somewhere inside @ancestor, possibly with * intermediate containers. * * Returns: %TRUE if @ancestor contains @widget as a child, * grandchild, great grandchild, etc. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *ancestor) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (ancestor != NULL, FALSE); while (widget) { if (widget->priv->parent == ancestor) return TRUE; widget = widget->priv->parent; } return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection old_dir) { GtkTextDirection direction; GtkStateFlags state; gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); direction = _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget); switch (direction) { case GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR: state = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR; break; case GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL: state = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL; break; case GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE: default: g_assert_not_reached (); break; } gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, state, state ^ (GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR | GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL)); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED], 0, old_dir); } /** * gtk_widget_set_direction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @dir: the new direction * * Sets the reading direction on a particular widget. This direction * controls the primary direction for widgets containing text, * and also the direction in which the children of a container are * packed. The ability to set the direction is present in order * so that correct localization into languages with right-to-left * reading directions can be done. Generally, applications will * let the default reading direction present, except for containers * where the containers are arranged in an order that is explicitly * visual rather than logical (such as buttons for text justification). * * If the direction is set to %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE, then the value * set by gtk_widget_set_default_direction() will be used. **/ void gtk_widget_set_direction (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection dir) { GtkTextDirection old_dir; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (dir >= GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE && dir <= GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL); old_dir = _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget); widget->priv->direction = dir; if (old_dir != _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)) gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); } /** * gtk_widget_get_direction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the reading direction for a particular widget. See * gtk_widget_set_direction(). * * Returns: the reading direction for the widget. **/ GtkTextDirection gtk_widget_get_direction (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) return gtk_default_direction; else return widget->priv->direction; } static void gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) { GtkTextDirection old_dir = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (data); GtkWidget *child; g_object_ref (widget); if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (child, data); } g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_set_default_direction: * @dir: the new default direction. This cannot be * %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE. * * Sets the default reading direction for widgets where the * direction has not been explicitly set by gtk_widget_set_direction(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_default_direction (GtkTextDirection dir) { g_return_if_fail (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL || dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); if (dir != gtk_default_direction) { GList *toplevels, *tmp_list; GtkTextDirection old_dir = gtk_default_direction; gtk_default_direction = dir; tmp_list = toplevels = gtk_window_list_toplevels (); g_list_foreach (toplevels, (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL); while (tmp_list) { gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (tmp_list->data, GUINT_TO_POINTER (old_dir)); g_object_unref (tmp_list->data); tmp_list = tmp_list->next; } g_list_free (toplevels); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_default_direction: * * Obtains the current default reading direction. See * gtk_widget_set_default_direction(). * * Returns: the current default direction. **/ GtkTextDirection gtk_widget_get_default_direction (void) { return gtk_default_direction; } static void gtk_widget_constructed (GObject *object) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPath *path; /* As strange as it may seem, this may happen on object construction. * init() implementations of parent types may eventually call this function, * each with its corresponding GType, which could leave a child * implementation with a wrong widget type in the widget path */ path = (GtkWidgetPath*)g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_widget_path); if (path && G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget) != gtk_widget_path_get_object_type (path)) g_object_set_qdata (object, quark_widget_path, NULL); G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->constructed (object); if (!widget->priv->no_window_set) { g_warning ("%s does not call gtk_widget_set_has_window() in its init function", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); } } static void gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GSList *sizegroups; if (priv->parent && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (priv->parent)) gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget); else if (priv->parent) gtk_widget_unparent (widget); else if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_hide (widget); priv->visible = FALSE; if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); g_clear_object (&priv->cursor); if (!priv->in_destruction) { priv->in_destruction = TRUE; g_signal_emit (object, widget_signals[DESTROY], 0); priv->in_destruction = FALSE; } sizegroups = _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (widget); while (sizegroups) { GtkSizeGroup *size_group; size_group = sizegroups->data; sizegroups = sizegroups->next; gtk_size_group_remove_widget (size_group, widget); } g_object_set_qdata (object, quark_action_muxer, NULL); while (priv->attached_windows) gtk_window_set_attached_to (priv->attached_windows->data, NULL); G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->dispose (object); } #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS typedef struct { AutomaticChildClass *child_class; GType widget_type; GObject *object; gboolean did_finalize; } FinalizeAssertion; static void finalize_assertion_weak_ref (gpointer data, GObject *where_the_object_was) { FinalizeAssertion *assertion = (FinalizeAssertion *)data; assertion->did_finalize = TRUE; } static FinalizeAssertion * finalize_assertion_new (GtkWidget *widget, GType widget_type, AutomaticChildClass *child_class) { FinalizeAssertion *assertion = NULL; GObject *object; object = gtk_widget_get_template_child (widget, widget_type, child_class->name); /* We control the hash table entry, the object should never be NULL */ g_assert (object); if (!G_IS_OBJECT (object)) g_critical ("Automated component '%s' of class '%s' seems to have been prematurely finalized", child_class->name, g_type_name (widget_type)); else { assertion = g_slice_new0 (FinalizeAssertion); assertion->child_class = child_class; assertion->widget_type = widget_type; assertion->object = object; g_object_weak_ref (object, finalize_assertion_weak_ref, assertion); } return assertion; } static GSList * build_finalize_assertion_list (GtkWidget *widget) { GType class_type; GtkWidgetClass *class; GSList *l, *list = NULL; for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) { if (!class->priv->template) continue; class_type = G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (class); for (l = class->priv->template->children; l; l = l->next) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; FinalizeAssertion *assertion; assertion = finalize_assertion_new (widget, class_type, child_class); list = g_slist_prepend (list, assertion); } } return list; } #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ static void gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object) { /* gtk_object_destroy() will already hold a refcount on object */ GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children)) { GtkWidgetClass *class; GSList *l; #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS GSList *assertions = NULL; /* Note, GTK_WIDGET_ASSERT_COMPONENTS is very useful * to catch ref counting bugs, but can only be used in * test cases which simply create and destroy a composite * widget. * * This is because some API can expose components explicitly, * and so we cannot assert that a component is expected to finalize * in a full application ecosystem. */ if (g_getenv ("GTK_WIDGET_ASSERT_COMPONENTS") != NULL) assertions = build_finalize_assertion_list (widget); #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ /* Release references to all automated children */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children, NULL); #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS for (l = assertions; l; l = l->next) { FinalizeAssertion *assertion = l->data; if (!assertion->did_finalize) g_critical ("Automated component '%s' of class '%s' did not finalize in gtk_widget_destroy(). " "Current reference count is %d", assertion->child_class->name, g_type_name (assertion->widget_type), assertion->object->ref_count); g_slice_free (FinalizeAssertion, assertion); } g_slist_free (assertions); #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ /* Set any automatic private data pointers to NULL */ for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) { if (!class->priv->template) continue; for (l = class->priv->template->children; l; l = l->next) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; if (child_class->offset != 0) { gpointer field_p; /* Nullify instance private data for internal children */ field_p = G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (widget, child_class->offset); (* (gpointer *) field_p) = NULL; } } } } if (priv->accessible) { gtk_accessible_set_widget (GTK_ACCESSIBLE (priv->accessible), NULL); g_object_unref (priv->accessible); priv->accessible = NULL; } /* wipe accelerator closures (keep order) */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, NULL); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, NULL); /* Callers of add_mnemonic_label() should disconnect on ::destroy */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, NULL); gtk_grab_remove (widget); destroy_tick_callbacks (widget); } static void gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *l; gtk_grab_remove (widget); g_free (priv->name); g_clear_object (&priv->accessible); gtk_widget_clear_path (widget); gtk_css_widget_node_widget_destroyed (GTK_CSS_WIDGET_NODE (priv->cssnode)); g_object_unref (priv->cssnode); g_clear_object (&priv->context); _gtk_size_request_cache_free (&priv->requests); for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { EventControllerData *data = l->data; if (data->controller) _gtk_widget_remove_controller (widget, data->controller); } g_list_free_full (priv->event_controllers, g_free); priv->event_controllers = NULL; if (_gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget) != NULL) { GtkWidget *child; g_warning ("Finalizing %s %p, but it still has children left:", gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { g_warning (" - %s %p", gtk_widget_get_name (child), child); } } if (g_object_is_floating (object)) g_warning ("A floating object was finalized. This means that someone\n" "called g_object_unref() on an object that had only a floating\n" "reference; the initial floating reference is not owned by anyone\n" "and must be removed with g_object_ref_sink()."); G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->finalize (object); } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_map: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { GtkWidget *p; priv->mapped = TRUE; if (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_show (priv->window); for (p = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); p != NULL; p = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (p)) { if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (p) && _gtk_widget_get_child_visible (p) && !_gtk_widget_get_mapped (p)) gtk_widget_map (p); } } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_unmap: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { GtkWidget *child; priv->mapped = FALSE; if (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_hide (priv->window); for (child = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_unmap (child); } gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT | GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE); } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_realize: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (!_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, TRUE); if (priv->parent) { priv->window = gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget); g_object_ref (priv->window); } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_unrealize: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped); /* We must do unrealize child widget BEFORE container widget. * gdk_window_destroy() destroys specified xwindow and its sub-xwindows. * So, unrealizing container widget before its children causes the problem * (for example, gdk_ic_destroy () with destroyed window causes crash.) */ gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback)gtk_widget_unrealize, NULL); if (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { gtk_widget_unregister_window (widget, priv->window); gdk_window_destroy (priv->window); priv->window = NULL; } else { g_object_unref (priv->window); priv->window = NULL; } gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE); } void gtk_widget_adjust_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL && priv->width > 0) *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, priv->width); else if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL && priv->height > 0) *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, priv->height); /* Fix it if set_size_request made natural size smaller than min size. * This would also silently fix broken widgets, but we warn about them * in gtksizerequest.c when calling their size request vfuncs. */ *natural_size = MAX (*natural_size, *minimum_size); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { *minimum_size += priv->margin.left + priv->margin.right; *natural_size += priv->margin.left + priv->margin.right; } else { *minimum_size += priv->margin.top + priv->margin.bottom; *natural_size += priv->margin.top + priv->margin.bottom; } } void gtk_widget_adjust_baseline_request (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_baseline, gint *natural_baseline) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (priv->height >= 0) { /* No baseline support for explicitly set height */ *minimum_baseline = -1; *natural_baseline = -1; } else { *minimum_baseline += priv->margin.top; *natural_baseline += priv->margin.top; } } static gboolean is_my_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { gpointer user_data; if (!window) return FALSE; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data); return (user_data == widget); } /* * _gtk_widget_get_device_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Returns: (nullable): the window of @widget that @device is in, or %NULL */ GdkWindow * _gtk_widget_get_device_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GdkWindow *window; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), NULL); if (gdk_device_get_source (device) == GDK_SOURCE_KEYBOARD) return NULL; window = gdk_device_get_last_event_window (device); if (window && is_my_window (widget, window)) return window; else return NULL; } /* * _gtk_widget_list_devices: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the list of pointer #GdkDevices that are currently * on top of any window belonging to @widget. Free the list * with g_list_free(), the elements are owned by GTK+ and must * not be freed. */ GList * _gtk_widget_list_devices (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkSeat *seat; GList *result = NULL; GList *devices; GList *l; GdkDevice *device; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) return NULL; seat = gdk_display_get_default_seat (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); device = gdk_seat_get_pointer (seat); if (is_my_window (widget, gdk_device_get_last_event_window (device))) result = g_list_prepend (result, device); devices = gdk_seat_get_slaves (seat, GDK_SEAT_CAPABILITY_ALL_POINTING); for (l = devices; l; l = l->next) { device = l->data; if (is_my_window (widget, gdk_device_get_last_event_window (device))) result = g_list_prepend (result, device); } g_list_free (devices); return result; } static void synth_crossing (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventType type, GdkWindow *window, GdkDevice *device, GdkCrossingMode mode, GdkNotifyType detail) { GdkEvent *event; event = gdk_event_new (type); event->any.window = g_object_ref (window); event->any.send_event = TRUE; event->crossing.subwindow = g_object_ref (window); event->crossing.time = GDK_CURRENT_TIME; gdk_device_get_position_double (device, &event->crossing.x_root, &event->crossing.y_root); gdk_window_get_device_position_double (window, device, &event->crossing.x, &event->crossing.y, NULL); event->crossing.mode = mode; event->crossing.detail = detail; event->crossing.focus = FALSE; event->crossing.state = 0; gdk_event_set_device (event, device); if (!widget) widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event); if (widget) gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); g_object_unref (event); } /* * _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing: * @from: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is leaving. * @to: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is moving to. * @mode: the #GdkCrossingMode to place on the synthesized events. * * Generate crossing event(s) on widget state (sensitivity) or GTK+ grab change. * * The real pointer window is the window that most recently received an enter notify * event. Windows that don’t select for crossing events can’t become the real * pointer window. The real pointer widget that owns the real pointer window. The * effective pointer window is the same as the real pointer window unless the real * pointer widget is either insensitive or there is a grab on a widget that is not * an ancestor of the real pointer widget (in which case the effective pointer * window should be the root window). * * When the effective pointer window is the same as the real pointer window, we * receive crossing events from the windowing system. When the effective pointer * window changes to become different from the real pointer window we synthesize * crossing events, attempting to follow X protocol rules: * * When the root window becomes the effective pointer window: * - leave notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor * - leave notify on all of its ancestors, detail Virtual * - enter notify on root window, detail Inferior * * When the root window ceases to be the effective pointer window: * - leave notify on root window, detail Inferior * - enter notify on all ancestors of real pointer window, detail Virtual * - enter notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor */ void _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (GtkWidget *from, GtkWidget *to, GdkDevice *device, GdkCrossingMode mode) { GdkWindow *from_window = NULL, *to_window = NULL; g_return_if_fail (from != NULL || to != NULL); if (from != NULL) { from_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (from, device); if (!from_window) from_window = from->priv->window; } if (to != NULL) { to_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (to, device); if (!to_window) to_window = to->priv->window; } if (from_window == NULL && to_window == NULL) ; else if (from_window != NULL && to_window == NULL) { GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window; while (from_ancestor != NULL) { from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_parent (from_ancestor); if (from_ancestor == NULL) break; from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor); } synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } /* XXX: enter/inferior on root window? */ g_list_free (from_ancestors); } else if (from_window == NULL && to_window != NULL) { GList *to_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *to_ancestor = to_window; while (to_ancestor != NULL) { to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_parent (to_ancestor); if (to_ancestor == NULL) break; to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor); } /* XXX: leave/inferior on root window? */ for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); g_list_free (to_ancestors); } else if (from_window == to_window) ; else { GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *to_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window, *to_ancestor = to_window; while (from_ancestor != NULL || to_ancestor != NULL) { if (from_ancestor != NULL) { from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_parent (from_ancestor); if (from_ancestor == to_window) break; if (from_ancestor) from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor); } if (to_ancestor != NULL) { to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_parent (to_ancestor); if (to_ancestor == from_window) break; if (to_ancestor) to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor); } } if (to_ancestor == from_window) { if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_UNGRAB) synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR); for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); } else if (from_ancestor == to_window) { synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_GRAB) synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR); } else { while (from_ancestors != NULL && to_ancestors != NULL && from_ancestors->data == to_ancestors->data) { from_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (from_ancestors, from_ancestors); to_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (to_ancestors, to_ancestors); } synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL); } for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL); } synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); } g_list_free (from_ancestors); g_list_free (to_ancestors); } } static void gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkStateData *data) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkStateFlags new_flags, old_flags = priv->state_flags; GtkStateData child_data; GtkWidget *child; gint new_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); priv->state_flags |= data->flags_to_set; priv->state_flags &= ~(data->flags_to_unset); /* make insensitivity unoverridable */ if (!priv->sensitive) priv->state_flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; if (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget) && !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) { GtkWidget *window; window = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (window && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window)) gtk_window_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (window), NULL); } new_flags = priv->state_flags; if (data->old_scale_factor != new_scale_factor) _gtk_widget_scale_changed (widget); if (old_flags != new_flags) { g_object_ref (widget); if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && gtk_widget_has_grab (widget)) gtk_grab_remove (widget); gtk_style_context_set_state (_gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), new_flags); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED], 0, old_flags); if (!priv->shadowed && (new_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) != (old_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) { GList *event_windows = NULL; GList *devices, *d; devices = _gtk_widget_list_devices (widget); for (d = devices; d; d = d->next) { GdkWindow *window; GdkDevice *device; device = d->data; window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (widget, device); /* Do not propagate more than once to the * same window if non-multidevice aware. */ if (!gdk_window_get_support_multidevice (window) && g_list_find (event_windows, window)) continue; if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (widget, NULL, d->data, GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); else _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (NULL, widget, d->data, GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); event_windows = g_list_prepend (event_windows, window); } g_list_free (event_windows); g_list_free (devices); } if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) gtk_widget_reset_controllers (widget); /* Make sure to only propagate the right states further */ child_data.old_scale_factor = new_scale_factor; child_data.flags_to_set = data->flags_to_set & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE; child_data.flags_to_unset = data->flags_to_unset & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE; if (child_data.flags_to_set != 0 || child_data.flags_to_unset != 0) { for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_propagate_state (child, &child_data); } } g_object_unref (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_shape_combine_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape * * Sets a shape for this widget’s GDK window. This allows for * transparent windows etc., see gdk_window_shape_combine_region() * for more information. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* set_shape doesn't work on widgets without GDK window */ g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (region == NULL) { priv->has_shape_mask = FALSE; if (priv->window) gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, NULL, 0, 0); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info, NULL); } else { priv->has_shape_mask = TRUE; g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info, cairo_region_copy (region), (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); /* set shape if widget has a GDK window already. * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize(). */ if (priv->window) gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); } } static void gtk_widget_update_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; /* set shape if widget has a GDK window already. * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize(). */ if (priv->window) { cairo_region_t *region; cairo_region_t *csd_region; cairo_region_t *app_region; gboolean free_region; app_region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info); csd_region = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region"); free_region = FALSE; if (app_region && csd_region) { free_region = TRUE; region = cairo_region_copy (app_region); cairo_region_intersect (region, csd_region); } else if (app_region) region = app_region; else if (csd_region) region = csd_region; else region = NULL; gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); if (free_region) cairo_region_destroy (region); } } void gtk_widget_set_csd_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget, const cairo_region_t *region) { if (region == NULL) g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region", NULL); else g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region", cairo_region_copy (region), (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape * * Sets an input shape for this widget’s GDK window. This allows for * windows which react to mouse click in a nonrectangular region, see * gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region() for more information. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* set_shape doesn't work on widgets without GDK window */ g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); if (region == NULL) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, NULL); else g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, cairo_region_copy (region), (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); } /** * gtk_requisition_new: * * Allocates a new #GtkRequisition-struct and initializes its elements to zero. * * Returns: a new empty #GtkRequisition. The newly allocated #GtkRequisition should * be freed with gtk_requisition_free(). * * Since: 3.0 */ GtkRequisition * gtk_requisition_new (void) { return g_slice_new0 (GtkRequisition); } /** * gtk_requisition_copy: * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition * * Copies a #GtkRequisition. * * Returns: a copy of @requisition **/ GtkRequisition * gtk_requisition_copy (const GtkRequisition *requisition) { return g_slice_dup (GtkRequisition, requisition); } /** * gtk_requisition_free: * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition * * Frees a #GtkRequisition. **/ void gtk_requisition_free (GtkRequisition *requisition) { g_slice_free (GtkRequisition, requisition); } G_DEFINE_BOXED_TYPE (GtkRequisition, gtk_requisition, gtk_requisition_copy, gtk_requisition_free) /** * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type: * @widget_class: class to set the accessible type for * @type: The object type that implements the accessible for @widget_class * * Sets the type to be used for creating accessibles for widgets of * @widget_class. The given @type must be a subtype of the type used for * accessibles of the parent class. * * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets. * * Since: 3.2 **/ void gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, GType type) { GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, widget_class->priv->accessible_type)); priv = widget_class->priv; priv->accessible_type = type; /* reset this - honoring the type's role is better. */ priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID; } /** * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role: * @widget_class: class to set the accessible role for * @role: The role to use for accessibles created for @widget_class * * Sets the default #AtkRole to be set on accessibles created for * widgets of @widget_class. Accessibles may decide to not honor this * setting if their role reporting is more refined. Calls to * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type() will reset this value. * * In cases where you want more fine-grained control over the role of * accessibles created for @widget_class, you should provide your own * accessible type and use gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type() * instead. * * If @role is #ATK_ROLE_INVALID, the default role will not be changed * and the accessible’s default role will be used instead. * * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets. * * Since: 3.2 **/ void gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, AtkRole role) { GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); priv = widget_class->priv; priv->accessible_role = role; } /** * _gtk_widget_peek_accessible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the accessible for @widget, if it has been created yet. * Otherwise, this function returns %NULL. If the @widget’s implementation * does not use the default way to create accessibles, %NULL will always be * returned. * * Returns: (nullable): the accessible for @widget or %NULL if none has been * created yet. **/ AtkObject * _gtk_widget_peek_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->accessible; } /** * gtk_widget_get_accessible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the accessible object that describes the widget to an * assistive technology. * * If accessibility support is not available, this #AtkObject * instance may be a no-op. Likewise, if no class-specific #AtkObject * implementation is available for the widget instance in question, * it will inherit an #AtkObject implementation from the first ancestor * class for which such an implementation is defined. * * The documentation of the * [ATK](http://developer.gnome.org/atk/stable/) * library contains more information about accessible objects and their uses. * * Returns: (transfer none): the #AtkObject associated with @widget */ AtkObject* gtk_widget_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_accessible (widget); } static AtkObject* gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) { AtkObject* accessible; accessible = widget->priv->accessible; if (!accessible) { GtkWidgetClass *widget_class; GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; AtkObjectFactory *factory; AtkRegistry *default_registry; widget_class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); priv = widget_class->priv; if (priv->accessible_type == GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE) { default_registry = atk_get_default_registry (); factory = atk_registry_get_factory (default_registry, G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget)); accessible = atk_object_factory_create_accessible (factory, G_OBJECT (widget)); if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); widget->priv->accessible = accessible; } else { accessible = g_object_new (priv->accessible_type, "widget", widget, NULL); if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); widget->priv->accessible = accessible; atk_object_initialize (accessible, widget); /* Set the role again, since we don't want a role set * in some parent initialize() function to override * our own. */ if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); } } return accessible; } /* * Initialize a AtkImplementorIface instance’s virtual pointers as * appropriate to this implementor’s class (GtkWidget). */ static void gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface) { iface->ref_accessible = gtk_widget_ref_accessible; } static AtkObject* gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor) { AtkObject *accessible; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (implementor)); if (accessible) g_object_ref (accessible); return accessible; } /* * Expand flag management */ static void gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; priv = widget->priv; if (priv->need_compute_expand) { gboolean h, v; if (priv->hexpand_set) h = priv->hexpand; else h = FALSE; if (priv->vexpand_set) v = priv->vexpand; else v = FALSE; /* we don't need to use compute_expand if both expands are * forced by the app */ if (!(priv->hexpand_set && priv->vexpand_set)) { if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand != NULL) { gboolean ignored; GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand (widget, priv->hexpand_set ? &ignored : &h, priv->vexpand_set ? &ignored : &v); } } priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; priv->computed_hexpand = h != FALSE; priv->computed_vexpand = v != FALSE; } } /** * gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Mark @widget as needing to recompute its expand flags. Call * this function when setting legacy expand child properties * on the child of a container. * * See gtk_widget_compute_expand(). */ void gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; gboolean changed_anything; if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand) return; changed_anything = FALSE; parent = widget; while (parent != NULL) { if (!parent->priv->need_compute_expand) { parent->priv->need_compute_expand = TRUE; changed_anything = TRUE; } /* Note: if we had an invariant that "if a child needs to * compute expand, its parents also do" then we could stop going * up when we got to a parent that already needed to * compute. However, in general we compute expand lazily (as * soon as we see something in a subtree that is expand, we know * we're expanding) and so this invariant does not hold and we * have to always walk all the way up in case some ancestor * is not currently need_compute_expand. */ parent = parent->priv->parent; } /* recomputing expand always requires * a relayout as well */ if (changed_anything) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_compute_expand: * @widget: the widget * @orientation: expand direction * * Computes whether a container should give this widget extra space * when possible. Containers should check this, rather than * looking at gtk_widget_get_hexpand() or gtk_widget_get_vexpand(). * * This function already checks whether the widget is visible, so * visibility does not need to be checked separately. Non-visible * widgets are not expanded. * * The computed expand value uses either the expand setting explicitly * set on the widget itself, or, if none has been explicitly set, * the widget may expand if some of its children do. * * Returns: whether widget tree rooted here should be expanded */ gboolean gtk_widget_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); /* We never make a widget expand if not even showing. */ if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) return FALSE; gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (widget); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) return widget->priv->computed_hexpand; else return widget->priv->computed_vexpand; } static void gtk_widget_set_expand (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gboolean expand) { gint expand_prop; gint expand_set_prop; gboolean was_both; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; expand = expand != FALSE; was_both = priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { if (priv->hexpand_set && priv->hexpand == expand) return; priv->hexpand_set = TRUE; priv->hexpand = expand; expand_prop = PROP_HEXPAND; expand_set_prop = PROP_HEXPAND_SET; } else { if (priv->vexpand_set && priv->vexpand == expand) return; priv->vexpand_set = TRUE; priv->vexpand = expand; expand_prop = PROP_VEXPAND; expand_set_prop = PROP_VEXPAND_SET; } gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[expand_prop]); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[expand_set_prop]); if (was_both != (priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand)) g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_EXPAND]); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); } static void gtk_widget_set_expand_set (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gboolean set) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; gint prop; priv = widget->priv; set = set != FALSE; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { if (set == priv->hexpand_set) return; priv->hexpand_set = set; prop = PROP_HEXPAND_SET; } else { if (set == priv->vexpand_set) return; priv->vexpand_set = set; prop = PROP_VEXPAND_SET; } gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[prop]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_hexpand: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to * expand. * * Containers should use gtk_widget_compute_expand() rather than * this function, to see whether a widget, or any of its children, * has the expand flag set. If any child of a widget wants to * expand, the parent may ask to expand also. * * This function only looks at the widget’s own hexpand flag, rather * than computing whether the entire widget tree rooted at this widget * wants to expand. * * Returns: whether hexpand flag is set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->hexpand; } /** * gtk_widget_set_hexpand: * @widget: the widget * @expand: whether to expand * * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to * expand. * * Call this function to set the expand flag if you would like your * widget to become larger horizontally when the window has extra * room. * * By default, widgets automatically expand if any of their children * want to expand. (To see if a widget will automatically expand given * its current children and state, call gtk_widget_compute_expand(). A * container can decide how the expandability of children affects the * expansion of the container by overriding the compute_expand virtual * method on #GtkWidget.). * * Setting hexpand explicitly with this function will override the * automatic expand behavior. * * This function forces the widget to expand or not to expand, * regardless of children. The override occurs because * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() sets the hexpand-set property (see * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set()) which causes the widget’s hexpand * value to be used, rather than looking at children and widget state. */ void gtk_widget_set_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean expand) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, expand); } /** * gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_hexpand() has been used to * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. * * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not * set, then the expand value depends on whether any * children of the widget would like to expand. * * There are few reasons to use this function, but it’s here * for completeness and consistency. * * Returns: whether hexpand has been explicitly set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->hexpand_set; } /** * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * @set: value for hexpand-set property * * Sets whether the hexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_hexpand()) will * be used. * * The hexpand-set property will be set automatically when you call * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() to set hexpand, so the most likely * reason to use this function would be to unset an explicit expand * flag. * * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not * set, then the expand value depends on whether any * children of the widget would like to expand. * * There are few reasons to use this function, but it’s here * for completeness and consistency. */ void gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean set) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, set); } /** * gtk_widget_get_vexpand: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical * space. * * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand() for more detail. * * Returns: whether vexpand flag is set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->vexpand; } /** * gtk_widget_set_vexpand: * @widget: the widget * @expand: whether to expand * * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical * space. * * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand() for more detail. */ void gtk_widget_set_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean expand) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, expand); } /** * gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_vexpand() has been used to * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. * * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set() for more detail. * * Returns: whether vexpand has been explicitly set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->vexpand_set; } /** * gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * @set: value for vexpand-set property * * Sets whether the vexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_vexpand()) will * be used. * * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set() for more detail. */ void gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean set) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, set); } /* * GtkBuildable implementation */ static GQuark quark_builder_has_default = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_has_focus = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_atk_relations = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_set_name = 0; static void gtk_widget_buildable_add_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *type) { gtk_widget_set_parent (GTK_WIDGET (child), GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); } static void gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface) { quark_builder_has_default = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-default"); quark_builder_has_focus = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-focus"); quark_builder_atk_relations = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-atk-relations"); quark_builder_set_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-set-name"); iface->set_name = gtk_widget_buildable_set_name; iface->get_name = gtk_widget_buildable_get_name; iface->get_internal_child = gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child; iface->set_buildable_property = gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property; iface->parser_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished; iface->custom_tag_start = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start; iface->custom_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished; iface->add_child = gtk_widget_buildable_add_child; } static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, const gchar *name) { g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name, g_strdup (name), g_free); } static const gchar * gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable) { return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name); } static GObject * gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *childname) { GtkWidgetClass *class; GSList *l; GType internal_child_type = 0; if (strcmp (childname, "accessible") == 0) return G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable))); /* Find a widget type which has declared an automated child as internal by * the name 'childname', if any. */ for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (buildable); GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) { GtkWidgetTemplate *template = class->priv->template; if (!template) continue; for (l = template->children; l && internal_child_type == 0; l = l->next) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; if (child_class->internal_child && strcmp (childname, child_class->name) == 0) internal_child_type = G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (class); } } /* Now return the 'internal-child' from the class which declared it, note * that gtk_widget_get_template_child() an API used to access objects * which are in the private scope of a given class. */ if (internal_child_type != 0) return gtk_widget_get_template_child (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), internal_child_type, childname); return NULL; } static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *name, const GValue *value) { if (strcmp (name, "has-default") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value)) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default, GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE)); else if (strcmp (name, "has-focus") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value)) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus, GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE)); else g_object_set_property (G_OBJECT (buildable), name, value); } typedef struct { gchar *action_name; GString *description; gchar *context; gboolean translatable; } AtkActionData; typedef struct { gchar *target; AtkRelationType type; gint line; gint col; } AtkRelationData; static void free_action (AtkActionData *data, gpointer user_data) { g_free (data->action_name); g_string_free (data->description, TRUE); g_free (data->context); g_slice_free (AtkActionData, data); } static void free_relation (AtkRelationData *data, gpointer user_data) { g_free (data->target); g_slice_free (AtkRelationData, data); } static void gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder) { GSList *atk_relations; if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default)) { gtk_widget_grab_default (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default); } if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus)) { gtk_widget_grab_focus (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus); } atk_relations = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations); if (atk_relations) { AtkObject *accessible; AtkRelationSet *relation_set; GSList *l; GObject *target; AtkObject *target_accessible; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); relation_set = atk_object_ref_relation_set (accessible); for (l = atk_relations; l; l = l->next) { AtkRelationData *relation = (AtkRelationData*)l->data; target = _gtk_builder_lookup_object (builder, relation->target, relation->line, relation->col); if (!target) continue; target_accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (target)); g_assert (target_accessible != NULL); atk_relation_set_add_relation_by_type (relation_set, relation->type, target_accessible); } g_object_unref (relation_set); g_slist_free_full (atk_relations, (GDestroyNotify) free_relation); g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations); } } typedef struct { GtkBuilder *builder; GSList *actions; GSList *relations; } AccessibilitySubParserData; static void accessibility_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; if (strcmp (element_name, "relation") == 0) { gchar *target = NULL; gchar *type = NULL; AtkRelationData *relation; AtkRelationType relation_type; if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "accessibility", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "target", &target, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "type", &type, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) { _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } relation_type = atk_relation_type_for_name (type); if (relation_type == ATK_RELATION_NULL) { g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, "No such relation type: '%s'", type); _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } relation = g_slice_new (AtkRelationData); relation->target = g_strdup (target); relation->type = relation_type; data->relations = g_slist_prepend (data->relations, relation); } else if (strcmp (element_name, "action") == 0) { const gchar *action_name; const gchar *description = NULL; const gchar *msg_context = NULL; gboolean translatable = FALSE; AtkActionData *action; if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "accessibility", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "action_name", &action_name, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "description", &description, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "comments", NULL, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "context", &msg_context, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_BOOLEAN|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "translatable", &translatable, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) { _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } action = g_slice_new (AtkActionData); action->action_name = g_strdup (action_name); action->description = g_string_new (description); action->context = g_strdup (msg_context); action->translatable = translatable; data->actions = g_slist_prepend (data->actions, action); } else if (strcmp (element_name, "accessibility") == 0) { if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID, NULL, NULL, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); } else { _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, "GtkWidget", element_name, error); } } static void accessibility_text (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *text, gsize text_len, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; if (strcmp (g_markup_parse_context_get_element (context), "action") == 0) { AtkActionData *action = data->actions->data; g_string_append_len (action->description, text, text_len); } } static const GMarkupParser accessibility_parser = { accessibility_start_element, NULL, accessibility_text, }; typedef struct { GObject *object; GtkBuilder *builder; guint key; guint modifiers; gchar *signal; } AccelGroupParserData; static void accel_group_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { AccelGroupParserData *data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; if (strcmp (element_name, "accelerator") == 0) { const gchar *key_str = NULL; const gchar *signal = NULL; const gchar *modifiers_str = NULL; guint key = 0; guint modifiers = 0; if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "key", &key_str, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "signal", &signal, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "modifiers", &modifiers_str, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) { _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } key = gdk_keyval_from_name (key_str); if (key == 0) { g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, "Could not parse key '%s'", key_str); _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } if (modifiers_str != NULL) { GFlagsValue aliases[2] = { { 0, "primary", "primary" }, { 0, NULL, NULL } }; aliases[0].value = _gtk_get_primary_accel_mod (); if (!_gtk_builder_flags_from_string (GDK_TYPE_MODIFIER_TYPE, aliases, modifiers_str, &modifiers, error)) { _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } } data->key = key; data->modifiers = modifiers; data->signal = g_strdup (signal); } else { _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, "GtkWidget", element_name, error); } } static const GMarkupParser accel_group_parser = { accel_group_start_element, }; typedef struct { GtkBuilder *builder; GSList *classes; } StyleParserData; static void style_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { StyleParserData *data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; if (strcmp (element_name, "class") == 0) { const gchar *name; if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "style", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "name", &name, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) { _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); return; } data->classes = g_slist_prepend (data->classes, g_strdup (name)); } else if (strcmp (element_name, "style") == 0) { if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) return; if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID, NULL, NULL, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); } else { _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, "GtkWidget", element_name, error); } } static const GMarkupParser style_parser = { style_start_element, }; static gboolean gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, GMarkupParser *parser, gpointer *parser_data) { if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) { AccelGroupParserData *data; data = g_slice_new0 (AccelGroupParserData); data->object = (GObject *)g_object_ref (buildable); data->builder = builder; *parser = accel_group_parser; *parser_data = data; return TRUE; } if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) { AccessibilitySubParserData *data; data = g_slice_new0 (AccessibilitySubParserData); data->builder = builder; *parser = accessibility_parser; *parser_data = data; return TRUE; } if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) { StyleParserData *data; data = g_slice_new0 (StyleParserData); data->builder = builder; *parser = style_parser; *parser_data = data; return TRUE; } return FALSE; } void _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *toplevel, gpointer user_data) { AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; GSList *accel_groups; GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (toplevel)); g_return_if_fail (user_data != NULL); accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; accel_groups = gtk_accel_groups_from_object (G_OBJECT (toplevel)); if (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 0) { accel_group = gtk_accel_group_new (); gtk_window_add_accel_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), accel_group); } else { g_assert (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 1); accel_group = g_slist_nth_data (accel_groups, 0); } gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object), accel_data->signal, accel_group, accel_data->key, accel_data->modifiers, GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE); g_object_unref (accel_data->object); g_free (accel_data->signal); g_slice_free (AccelGroupParserData, accel_data); } static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, gpointer user_data) { if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) { AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; GtkWidget *toplevel; accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; g_assert (accel_data->object); toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object)); _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), toplevel, user_data); } else if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) { AccessibilitySubParserData *a11y_data; a11y_data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; if (a11y_data->actions) { AtkObject *accessible; AtkAction *action; gint i, n_actions; GSList *l; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); if (ATK_IS_ACTION (accessible)) { action = ATK_ACTION (accessible); n_actions = atk_action_get_n_actions (action); for (l = a11y_data->actions; l; l = l->next) { AtkActionData *action_data = (AtkActionData*)l->data; for (i = 0; i < n_actions; i++) if (strcmp (atk_action_get_name (action, i), action_data->action_name) == 0) break; if (i < n_actions) { const gchar *description; if (action_data->translatable && action_data->description->len) description = _gtk_builder_parser_translate (gtk_builder_get_translation_domain (builder), action_data->context, action_data->description->str); else description = action_data->description->str; atk_action_set_description (action, i, description); } } } else g_warning ("accessibility action on a widget that does not implement AtkAction"); g_slist_free_full (a11y_data->actions, (GDestroyNotify) free_action); } if (a11y_data->relations) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations, a11y_data->relations); g_slice_free (AccessibilitySubParserData, a11y_data); } else if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) { StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; GtkStyleContext *context; GSList *l; context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); for (l = style_data->classes; l; l = l->next) gtk_style_context_add_class (context, (const gchar *)l->data); gtk_widget_reset_style (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); g_slist_free_full (style_data->classes, g_free); g_slice_free (StyleParserData, style_data); } } static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget) { /* By default widgets don't trade size at all. */ return GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_CONSTANT_SIZE; } static void gtk_widget_real_measure (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, int for_size, int *minimum, int *natural, int *minimum_baseline, int *natural_baseline) { *minimum = 0; *natural = 0; } /** * gtk_widget_get_halign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:halign property. * * For backwards compatibility reasons this method will never return * %GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE, but instead it will convert it to * %GTK_ALIGN_FILL. Baselines are not supported for horizontal * alignment. * * Returns: the horizontal alignment of @widget */ GtkAlign gtk_widget_get_halign (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkAlign align; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); align = widget->priv->halign; if (align == GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE) return GTK_ALIGN_FILL; return align; } /** * gtk_widget_set_halign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @align: the horizontal alignment * * Sets the horizontal alignment of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:halign property. */ void gtk_widget_set_halign (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAlign align) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->halign == align) return; widget->priv->halign = align; gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HALIGN]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_valign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:valign property. * * Returns: the vertical alignment of @widget */ GtkAlign gtk_widget_get_valign (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); return widget->priv->valign; } /** * gtk_widget_set_valign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @align: the vertical alignment * * Sets the vertical alignment of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:valign property. */ void gtk_widget_set_valign (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAlign align) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->valign == align) return; widget->priv->valign = align; gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VALIGN]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_start: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-start property. * * Returns: The start margin of @widget * * Since: 3.12 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_start (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->margin.left; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_start: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the start margin * * Sets the start margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-start property. * * Since: 3.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_start (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); /* We always save margin-start as .left */ if (widget->priv->margin.left == margin) return; widget->priv->margin.left = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_START]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_end: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-end property. * * Returns: The end margin of @widget * * Since: 3.12 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_end (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->margin.right; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_end: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the end margin * * Sets the end margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-end property. * * Since: 3.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_end (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); /* We always set margin-end as .right */ if (widget->priv->margin.right == margin) return; widget->priv->margin.right = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_END]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_top: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. * * Returns: The top margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->margin.top; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_top: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the top margin * * Sets the top margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); if (widget->priv->margin.top == margin) return; widget->priv->margin.top = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_TOP]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. * * Returns: The bottom margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->margin.bottom; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the bottom margin * * Sets the bottom margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); if (widget->priv->margin.bottom == margin) return; widget->priv->margin.bottom = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_clipboard: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This is a utility function to get the clipboard object for the * #GdkDisplay that @widget is using. * * Note that this function always works, even when @widget is not * realized yet. * * Returns: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. * * Since: 3.94 **/ GdkClipboard * gtk_widget_get_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gdk_display_get_clipboard (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_primary_clipboard: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This is a utility function to get the primary clipboard object * for the #GdkDisplay that @widget is using. * * Note that this function always works, even when @widget is not * realized yet. * * Returns: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. * * Since: 3.94 **/ GdkClipboard * gtk_widget_get_primary_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gdk_display_get_primary_clipboard (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns a newly allocated list of the widgets, normally labels, for * which this widget is the target of a mnemonic (see for example, * gtk_label_set_mnemonic_widget()). * The widgets in the list are not individually referenced. If you * want to iterate through the list and perform actions involving * callbacks that might destroy the widgets, you * must call `g_list_foreach (result, * (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL)` first, and then unref all the * widgets afterwards. * Returns: (element-type GtkWidget) (transfer container): the list of * mnemonic labels; free this list * with g_list_free() when you are done with it. * * Since: 2.4 **/ GList * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels (GtkWidget *widget) { GList *list = NULL; GSList *l; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); for (l = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); l; l = l->next) list = g_list_prepend (list, l->data); return list; } /** * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @label: a #GtkWidget that acts as a mnemonic label for @widget * * Adds a widget to the list of mnemonic labels for * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). Note the * list of mnemonic labels for the widget is cleared when the * widget is destroyed, so the caller must make sure to update * its internal state at this point as well, by using a connection * to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal or a weak notifier. * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *label) { GSList *old_list, *new_list; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); new_list = g_slist_prepend (old_list, label); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); } /** * gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @label: a #GtkWidget that was previously set as a mnemonic label for * @widget with gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). * * Removes a widget from the list of mnemonic labels for * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). The widget * must have previously been added to the list with * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *label) { GSList *old_list, *new_list; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); new_list = g_slist_remove (old_list, label); if (new_list) g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); } static void gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip, gboolean force) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (priv->has_tooltip != has_tooltip || force) { priv->has_tooltip = has_tooltip; g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP]); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @custom_window: (allow-none): a #GtkWindow, or %NULL * * Replaces the default window used for displaying * tooltips with @custom_window. GTK+ will take care of showing and * hiding @custom_window at the right moment, to behave likewise as * the default tooltip window. If @custom_window is %NULL, the default * tooltip window will be used. * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWindow *custom_window) { gboolean has_tooltip; gchar *tooltip_markup; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (custom_window == NULL || GTK_IS_WINDOW (custom_window)); tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); if (custom_window) g_object_ref (custom_window); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window, custom_window, g_object_unref); has_tooltip = (custom_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, has_tooltip, FALSE); if (has_tooltip && _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. This can be the * GtkWindow created by default, or the custom tooltip window set * using gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window(). * * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. * * Since: 2.12 */ GtkWindow * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window); } /** * gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Triggers a tooltip query on the display where the toplevel of @widget * is located. See gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query() for more * information. * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget) { gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); } static guint tooltip_query_id; static GSList *tooltip_query_displays; static gboolean tooltip_query_idle (gpointer data) { g_slist_foreach (tooltip_query_displays, (GFunc)gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query, NULL); g_slist_free_full (tooltip_query_displays, g_object_unref); tooltip_query_displays = NULL; tooltip_query_id = 0; return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkDisplay *display; display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); if (!g_slist_find (tooltip_query_displays, display)) tooltip_query_displays = g_slist_prepend (tooltip_query_displays, g_object_ref (display)); if (tooltip_query_id == 0) { tooltip_query_id = gdk_threads_add_idle (tooltip_query_idle, NULL); g_source_set_name_by_id (tooltip_query_id, "[gtk+] tooltip_query_idle"); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @text: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget * * Sets @text as the contents of the tooltip. This function will take * care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE and of the default * handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. * * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-text property and gtk_tooltip_set_text(). * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *text) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", text, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. * * Returns: (nullable): the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the * returned string with g_free() when done. * * Since: 2.12 */ gchar * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget) { gchar *text = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", &text, NULL); return text; } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @markup: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget, or %NULL * * Sets @markup as the contents of the tooltip, which is marked up with * the [Pango text markup language][PangoMarkupFormat]. * * This function will take care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE * and of the default handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. * * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup property and * gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *markup) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", markup, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. * * Returns: (nullable): the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the * returned string with g_free() when done. * * Since: 2.12 */ gchar * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget) { gchar *text = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", &text, NULL); return text; } /** * gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @has_tooltip: whether or not @widget has a tooltip. * * Sets the has-tooltip property on @widget to @has_tooltip. See * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, has_tooltip, FALSE); } /** * gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the current value of the has-tooltip property. See * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. * * Returns: current value of has-tooltip on @widget. * * Since: 2.12 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_tooltip; } /** * gtk_widget_get_clip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @clip: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to * * Retrieves the widget’s clip area. * * The clip area is the area in which all of @widget's drawing will * happen. Other toolkits call it the bounding box. * * Historically, in GTK+ the clip area has been equal to the allocation * retrieved via gtk_widget_get_allocation(). * * Since: 3.14 */ void gtk_widget_get_clip (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *clip) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (clip != NULL); priv = widget->priv; *clip = priv->clip; } /** * gtk_widget_set_clip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @clip: a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy from * * Sets the widget’s clip. This must not be used directly, * but from within a widget’s size_allocate method. * * The clip set should be the area that @widget draws on. If @widget is a * #GtkContainer, the area must contain all children's clips. * * If this function is not called by @widget during a ::size-allocate handler, * the clip will be set to @widget's allocation. */ static void gtk_widget_set_clip (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *clip) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder shadow; GtkBorder margin; GtkCssStyle *style; GdkRectangle new_clip; GtkAllocation allocation; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) || _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)); g_return_if_fail (clip != NULL); style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); _gtk_css_shadows_value_get_extents (gtk_css_style_get_value (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BOX_SHADOW), &shadow); /* The given clip is in @widget's coordinates, but we need it to be in the parent's coordinates, * just like priv->allocation is. So first we transform the clip, then union it with * the allocation (minus css margins) and then we add the box shadow size. */ new_clip = *clip; new_clip.x += priv->allocation.x + margin.left; new_clip.y += priv->allocation.y + margin.top; allocation = priv->allocation; allocation.x += margin.left; allocation.y += margin.top; allocation.width -= margin.left + margin.right; allocation.height -= margin.top + margin.bottom; gdk_rectangle_union (&allocation, &new_clip, &priv->clip); priv->clip.x -= shadow.left; priv->clip.y -= shadow.top; priv->clip.width += shadow.left + shadow.right; priv->clip.height += shadow.top + shadow.bottom; #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (GEOMETRY)) { gint depth; GtkWidget *parent; const gchar *name; const char *cssname; depth = 0; parent = widget; while (parent) { depth++; parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } name = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (G_OBJECT (widget))); cssname = gtk_css_node_get_name (priv->cssnode); g_message ("gtk_widget_set_clip: %s %s %d %d %d %d", name, cssname, priv->clip.x, priv->clip.y, priv->clip.width, priv->clip.height); } #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_size: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to * @baseline: (out) (allow-none): a pointer to an integer to copy to * * Retrieves the widget’s allocated size. * * This function returns the last values passed to * gtk_widget_size_allocate(). The value differs from * the size returned in gtk_widget_get_allocation() in that functions * like gtk_widget_set_halign() can adjust the allocation, but not * the value returned by this function. * * If a widget is not visible, its allocated size is 0. * * Since: 3.20 */ void gtk_widget_get_allocated_size (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation, int *baseline) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); priv = widget->priv; *allocation = priv->allocated_size; if (baseline) *baseline = priv->allocated_size_baseline; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocation: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to * * Retrieves the widget’s allocation. * * Note, when implementing a #GtkContainer: a widget’s allocation will * be its “adjusted” allocation, that is, the widget’s parent * container typically calls gtk_widget_size_allocate() with an * allocation, and that allocation is then adjusted (to handle margin * and alignment for example) before assignment to the widget. * gtk_widget_get_allocation() returns the adjusted allocation that * was actually assigned to the widget. The adjusted allocation is * guaranteed to be completely contained within the * gtk_widget_size_allocate() allocation, however. So a #GtkContainer * is guaranteed that its children stay inside the assigned bounds, * but not that they have exactly the bounds the container assigned. * * Since: 2.18 */ void gtk_widget_get_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); priv = widget->priv; *allocation = priv->allocation; } /** * gtk_widget_contains: * @widget: the widget to query * @x: X coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin * @y: Y coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin * * Tests if the point at (@x, @y) is contained in @widget. Points * inside the widget will respond to mouse and touch events, points * outside will not. * * The coordinates for (@x, @y) must be in widget coordinates, so * (0, 0) is assumed to be the top left of @widget's content area. * * Pass-through widgets and insensitive widgets do never respond to * input and will therefor always return %FALSE here. See * gtk_widget_set_pass_through() and gtk_widget_set_sensitive() for * details about those functions. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget contains (@x, @y). * * Since: 3.94 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_contains (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble x, gdouble y) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (gtk_widget_get_pass_through (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) return FALSE; return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->contains (widget, x, y); } /** * gtk_widget_pick: * @widget: the widget to query * @x: X coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin * @y: Y coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin * * Finds the descendant of widget (including widget itself) closest * to the screen at the point (@x, @y). The point must be given in * widget coordinates, so (0, 0) is assumed to be the top left of * @widget's content area. * * Usually widgets will return %NULL if the given coordinate is not * contained in @widget checked via gtk_widget_contains(). Otherwise * they will recursively try to find a child that does not return %NULL. * Widgets are however free to customize their picking algorithm. * * This function is used on the toplevel to determine the widget below * the mouse cursor for purposes of hover hilighting and delivering events. * * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): The widget descendant at the given * coordinate or %NULL if none. * * Since: 3.94 **/ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_pick (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble x, gdouble y) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); if (gtk_widget_get_pass_through (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) return NULL; return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->pick (widget, x, y); } void gtk_widget_get_outer_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GdkRectangle *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder margin; GtkCssStyle *style; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); *allocation = priv->allocation; allocation->x += margin.left; allocation->y += margin.top; allocation->width -= margin.left + margin.right; allocation->height -= margin.top + margin.bottom; } void gtk_widget_get_own_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GdkRectangle *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder margin, border, padding; GtkCssStyle *style; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); allocation->x = -padding.left - border.left; allocation->y = -padding.top - border.top; allocation->width = priv->allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right; allocation->height = priv->allocation.height -margin.top - margin.bottom; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width: * @widget: the widget to query * * Returns the width that has currently been allocated to @widget. * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers * for the #GtkWidget::draw function. * * Returns: the width of the @widget **/ int gtk_widget_get_allocated_width (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->allocation.width; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height: * @widget: the widget to query * * Returns the height that has currently been allocated to @widget. * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers * for the #GtkWidget::draw function. * * Returns: the height of the @widget **/ int gtk_widget_get_allocated_height (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->allocation.height; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline: * @widget: the widget to query * * Returns the baseline that has currently been allocated to @widget. * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers * for the #GtkWidget::draw function, and when allocating child * widgets in #GtkWidget::size_allocate. * * Returns: the baseline of the @widget, or -1 if none * * Since: 3.10 **/ int gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->allocated_baseline; } /** * gtk_widget_set_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @window: (transfer full): a #GdkWindow * * Sets a widget’s window. This function should only be used in a * widget’s #GtkWidget::realize implementation. The %window passed is * usually either new window created with gdk_window_new(), or the * window of its parent widget as returned by * gtk_widget_get_parent_window(). * * Widgets must indicate whether they will create their own #GdkWindow * by calling gtk_widget_set_has_window(). This is usually done in the * widget’s init() function. * * Note that this function does not add any reference to @window. * * Since: 2.18 */ void gtk_widget_set_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (window == NULL || GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->window != window) { priv->window = window; g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_WINDOW]); } } /** * gtk_widget_register_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @window: a #GdkWindow * * Registers a #GdkWindow with the widget and sets it up so that * the widget receives events for it. Call gtk_widget_unregister_window() * when destroying the window. * * Before 3.8 you needed to call gdk_window_set_user_data() directly to set * this up. This is now deprecated and you should use gtk_widget_register_window() * instead. Old code will keep working as is, although some new features like * transparency might not work perfectly. * * Since: 3.8 */ void gtk_widget_register_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; gpointer user_data; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data); g_assert (user_data == NULL); priv = widget->priv; gdk_window_set_user_data (window, widget); priv->registered_windows = g_list_prepend (priv->registered_windows, window); } /** * gtk_widget_unregister_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @window: a #GdkWindow * * Unregisters a #GdkWindow from the widget that was previously set up with * gtk_widget_register_window(). You need to call this when the window is * no longer used by the widget, such as when you destroy it. * * Since: 3.8 */ void gtk_widget_unregister_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; gpointer user_data; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); priv = widget->priv; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data); g_assert (user_data == widget); gdk_window_set_user_data (window, NULL); priv->registered_windows = g_list_remove (priv->registered_windows, window); } /** * gtk_widget_get_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget’s window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): @widget’s window. * * Since: 2.14 */ GdkWindow* gtk_widget_get_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->window; } /** * gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns %TRUE if @widget is multiple pointer aware. See * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice() for more information. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is multidevice aware. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->multidevice; } /** * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @support_multidevice: %TRUE to support input from multiple devices. * * Enables or disables multiple pointer awareness. If this setting is %TRUE, * @widget will start receiving multiple, per device enter/leave events. Note * that if custom #GdkWindows are created in #GtkWidget::realize, * gdk_window_set_support_multidevice() will have to be called manually on them. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean support_multidevice) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; priv->multidevice = (support_multidevice == TRUE); if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, support_multidevice); } /* There are multiple alpha related sources. First of all the user can specify alpha * in gtk_widget_set_opacity, secondly we can get it from the CSS opacity. These two * are multiplied together to form the total alpha. Secondly, the user can specify * an opacity group for a widget, which means we must essentially handle it as having alpha. */ static void gtk_widget_update_alpha (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkStyleContext *context; gdouble opacity; guint8 alpha; priv = widget->priv; context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); opacity = _gtk_css_number_value_get (_gtk_style_context_peek_property (context, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_OPACITY), 100); opacity = CLAMP (opacity, 0.0, 1.0); alpha = round (priv->user_alpha * opacity); if (alpha == priv->alpha) return; priv->alpha = alpha; if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) gdk_window_set_opacity (priv->window, priv->alpha / 255.0); gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_opacity: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @opacity: desired opacity, between 0 and 1 * * Request the @widget to be rendered partially transparent, * with opacity 0 being fully transparent and 1 fully opaque. (Opacity values * are clamped to the [0,1] range.). * This works on both toplevel widget, and child widgets, although there * are some limitations: * * For toplevel widgets this depends on the capabilities of the windowing * system. On X11 this has any effect only on X displays with a compositing manager * running. See gdk_display_is_composited(). On Windows it should work * always, although setting a window’s opacity after the window has been * shown causes it to flicker once on Windows. * * For child widgets it doesn’t work if any affected widget has a native window. * * Since: 3.8 **/ void gtk_widget_set_opacity (GtkWidget *widget, gdouble opacity) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; guint8 alpha; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; opacity = CLAMP (opacity, 0.0, 1.0); alpha = round (opacity * 255); if (alpha == priv->user_alpha) return; priv->user_alpha = alpha; gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_OPACITY]); } /** * gtk_widget_get_opacity: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Fetches the requested opacity for this widget. * See gtk_widget_set_opacity(). * * Returns: the requested opacity for this widget. * * Since: 3.8 **/ gdouble gtk_widget_get_opacity (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0.0); return widget->priv->user_alpha / 255.0; } /** * gtk_widget_send_focus_change: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @event: a #GdkEvent of type GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE * * Sends the focus change @event to @widget * * This function is not meant to be used by applications. The only time it * should be used is when it is necessary for a #GtkWidget to assign focus * to a widget that is semantically owned by the first widget even though * it’s not a direct child - for instance, a search entry in a floating * window similar to the quick search in #GtkTreeView. * * An example of its usage is: * * |[<!-- language="C" --> * GdkEvent *fevent = gdk_event_new (GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE); * * fevent->focus_change.type = GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE; * fevent->focus_change.in = TRUE; * fevent->focus_change.window = _gtk_widget_get_window (widget); * if (fevent->focus_change.window != NULL) * g_object_ref (fevent->focus_change.window); * * gtk_widget_send_focus_change (widget, fevent); * * g_object_unref (event); * ]| * * Returns: the return value from the event signal emission: %TRUE * if the event was handled, and %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.20 */ gboolean gtk_widget_send_focus_change (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event) { gboolean res; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL && event->any.type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE, FALSE); g_object_ref (widget); widget->priv->has_focus = event->focus_change.in; res = gtk_widget_event (widget, event); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HAS_FOCUS]); g_object_unref (widget); return res; } /** * gtk_widget_in_destruction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns whether the widget is currently being destroyed. * This information can sometimes be used to avoid doing * unnecessary work. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is being destroyed */ gboolean gtk_widget_in_destruction (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->in_destruction; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_anchored (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->anchored; } void _gtk_widget_set_anchored (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean anchored) { widget->priv->anchored = anchored; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->shadowed; } void _gtk_widget_set_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean shadowed) { widget->priv->shadowed = shadowed; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->alloc_needed; } static void gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; priv->alloc_needed = TRUE; do { if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) break; priv->alloc_needed_on_child = TRUE; if (!priv->visible) break; if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { gtk_container_queue_resize_handler (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); break; } widget = priv->parent; if (widget == NULL) break; priv = widget->priv; } while (TRUE); } gboolean gtk_widget_needs_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!priv->visible || !priv->child_visible) return FALSE; if (priv->resize_needed || priv->alloc_needed || priv->alloc_needed_on_child) return TRUE; return FALSE; } void gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_needs_allocate (widget)) return; gtk_widget_ensure_resize (widget); /* This code assumes that we only reach here if the previous * allocation is still valid (ie no resize was queued). * If that wasn't true, the parent would have taken care of * things. */ if (priv->alloc_needed) { GtkAllocation allocation; GtkAllocation clip; int baseline; gtk_widget_get_allocated_size (widget, &allocation, &baseline); gtk_widget_size_allocate (widget, &allocation, baseline, &clip); } else if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) { GtkWidget *child; priv->alloc_needed_on_child = FALSE; for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); child != NULL; child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) { gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (child); } } } void gtk_widget_ensure_resize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!priv->resize_needed) return; priv->resize_needed = FALSE; _gtk_size_request_cache_clear (&priv->requests); } void _gtk_widget_add_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer group) { GSList *groups; groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); groups = g_slist_prepend (groups, group); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); widget->priv->have_size_groups = TRUE; } void _gtk_widget_remove_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer group) { GSList *groups; groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); groups = g_slist_remove (groups, group); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); widget->priv->have_size_groups = groups != NULL; } GSList * _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (GtkWidget *widget) { if (widget->priv->have_size_groups) return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); return NULL; } void _gtk_widget_add_attached_window (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWindow *window) { widget->priv->attached_windows = g_list_prepend (widget->priv->attached_windows, window); } void _gtk_widget_remove_attached_window (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWindow *window) { widget->priv->attached_windows = g_list_remove (widget->priv->attached_windows, window); } /** * gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget: * @path: a widget path * @widget: the widget to append to the widget path * * Appends the data from @widget to the widget hierarchy represented * by @path. This function is a shortcut for adding information from * @widget to the given @path. This includes setting the name or * adding the style classes from @widget. * * Returns: the position where the data was inserted * * Since: 3.2 */ gint gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (GtkWidgetPath *path, GtkWidget *widget) { const GQuark *classes; guint n_classes, i; gint pos; g_return_val_if_fail (path != NULL, 0); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); pos = gtk_widget_path_append_type (path, gtk_css_node_get_widget_type (widget->priv->cssnode)); gtk_widget_path_iter_set_object_name (path, pos, gtk_css_node_get_name (widget->priv->cssnode)); if (widget->priv->name) gtk_widget_path_iter_set_name (path, pos, widget->priv->name); gtk_widget_path_iter_set_state (path, pos, widget->priv->state_flags); classes = gtk_css_node_list_classes (widget->priv->cssnode, &n_classes); for (i = n_classes; i-- > 0;) gtk_widget_path_iter_add_qclass (path, pos, classes[i]); return pos; } GtkWidgetPath * _gtk_widget_create_path (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; parent = widget->priv->parent; if (parent && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (parent)) return gtk_container_get_path_for_child (GTK_CONTAINER (parent), widget); else if (parent) { GtkWidgetPath *path = _gtk_widget_create_path (parent); gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (path, widget); return path; } else { /* Widget is either toplevel or unparented, treat both * as toplevels style wise, since there are situations * where style properties might be retrieved on that * situation. */ GtkWidget *attach_widget = NULL; GtkWidgetPath *result; if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) attach_widget = gtk_window_get_attached_to (GTK_WINDOW (widget)); if (attach_widget != NULL) result = gtk_widget_path_copy (gtk_widget_get_path (attach_widget)); else result = gtk_widget_path_new (); gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (result, widget); return result; } } /** * gtk_widget_get_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget, if the widget * is not connected to a toplevel widget, a partial path will be * created. * * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget **/ GtkWidgetPath * gtk_widget_get_path (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPath *path; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); path = (GtkWidgetPath*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_widget_path); if (!path) { path = _gtk_widget_create_path (widget); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_widget_path, path, (GDestroyNotify)gtk_widget_path_free); } return path; } void gtk_widget_clear_path (GtkWidget *widget) { g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_widget_path, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_class_set_css_name: * @widget_class: class to set the name on * @name: name to use * * Sets the name to be used for CSS matching of widgets. * * If this function is not called for a given class, the name * of the parent class is used. * * Since: 3.20 */ void gtk_widget_class_set_css_name (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, const char *name) { GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (name != NULL); priv = widget_class->priv; priv->css_name = g_intern_string (name); } static gboolean gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class) { return !(GTK_IS_WINDOW_CLASS (widget_class) || GTK_IS_POPOVER_CLASS (widget_class)); } /** * gtk_widget_class_get_css_name: * @widget_class: class to set the name on * * Gets the name used by this class for matching in CSS code. See * gtk_widget_class_set_css_name() for details. * * Returns: the CSS name of the given class * * Since: 3.20 */ const char * gtk_widget_class_get_css_name (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class), NULL); return widget_class->priv->css_name; } void _gtk_widget_style_context_invalidated (GtkWidget *widget) { g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0); } GtkCssNode * gtk_widget_get_css_node (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->cssnode; } GtkStyleContext * _gtk_widget_peek_style_context (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->context; } /** * gtk_widget_get_style_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the style context associated to @widget. The returned object is * guaranteed to be the same for the lifetime of @widget. * * Returns: (transfer none): a #GtkStyleContext. This memory is owned by @widget and * must not be freed. **/ GtkStyleContext * gtk_widget_get_style_context (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; if (G_UNLIKELY (priv->context == NULL)) { GdkDisplay *display; GdkFrameClock *frame_clock; priv->context = gtk_style_context_new_for_node (priv->cssnode); gtk_style_context_set_id (priv->context, priv->name); gtk_style_context_set_state (priv->context, priv->state_flags); gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); if (display) gtk_style_context_set_display (priv->context, display); frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); if (frame_clock) gtk_style_context_set_frame_clock (priv->context, frame_clock); if (priv->parent) gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, _gtk_widget_get_style_context (priv->parent)); } return widget->priv->context; } /** * gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @intent: the use case for the modifier mask * * Returns the modifier mask the @widget’s windowing system backend * uses for a particular purpose. * * See gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask(). * * Returns: the modifier mask used for @intent. * * Since: 3.4 **/ GdkModifierType gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask (GtkWidget *widget, GdkModifierIntent intent) { GdkDisplay *display; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); return gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask (gdk_keymap_get_for_display (display), intent); } static GtkActionMuxer * gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean create) { GtkWidget *parent; if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) return gtk_application_get_parent_muxer_for_window (GTK_WINDOW (widget)); if (GTK_IS_MENU (widget)) parent = gtk_menu_get_attach_widget (GTK_MENU (widget)); else if (GTK_IS_POPOVER (widget)) parent = gtk_popover_get_relative_to (GTK_POPOVER (widget)); else parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); if (parent) return _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (parent, create); return NULL; } void _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkActionMuxer *muxer; muxer = (GtkActionMuxer*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_action_muxer); if (muxer == NULL) return; gtk_action_muxer_set_parent (muxer, gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (widget, TRUE)); } GtkActionMuxer * _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean create) { GtkActionMuxer *muxer; muxer = (GtkActionMuxer*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_action_muxer); if (muxer) return muxer; if (create) { muxer = gtk_action_muxer_new (); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_action_muxer, muxer, g_object_unref); _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); return muxer; } else return gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (widget, FALSE); } /** * gtk_widget_insert_action_group: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @name: the prefix for actions in @group * @group: (allow-none): a #GActionGroup, or %NULL * * Inserts @group into @widget. Children of @widget that implement * #GtkActionable can then be associated with actions in @group by * setting their “action-name” to * @prefix.`action-name`. * * If @group is %NULL, a previously inserted group for @name is removed * from @widget. * * Since: 3.6 */ void gtk_widget_insert_action_group (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *name, GActionGroup *group) { GtkActionMuxer *muxer; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (name != NULL); muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, TRUE); if (group) gtk_action_muxer_insert (muxer, name, group); else gtk_action_muxer_remove (muxer, name); } /**************************************************************** * GtkBuilder automated templates * ****************************************************************/ static AutomaticChildClass * template_child_class_new (const gchar *name, gboolean internal_child, gssize offset) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class = g_slice_new0 (AutomaticChildClass); child_class->name = g_strdup (name); child_class->internal_child = internal_child; child_class->offset = offset; return child_class; } static void template_child_class_free (AutomaticChildClass *child_class) { if (child_class) { g_free (child_class->name); g_slice_free (AutomaticChildClass, child_class); } } static CallbackSymbol * callback_symbol_new (const gchar *name, GCallback callback) { CallbackSymbol *cb = g_slice_new0 (CallbackSymbol); cb->callback_name = g_strdup (name); cb->callback_symbol = callback; return cb; } static void callback_symbol_free (CallbackSymbol *callback) { if (callback) { g_free (callback->callback_name); g_slice_free (CallbackSymbol, callback); } } static void template_data_free (GtkWidgetTemplate *template_data) { if (template_data) { g_bytes_unref (template_data->data); g_slist_free_full (template_data->children, (GDestroyNotify)template_child_class_free); g_slist_free_full (template_data->callbacks, (GDestroyNotify)callback_symbol_free); if (template_data->connect_data && template_data->destroy_notify) template_data->destroy_notify (template_data->connect_data); g_slice_free (GtkWidgetTemplate, template_data); } } static GHashTable * get_auto_child_hash (GtkWidget *widget, GType type, gboolean create) { GHashTable *auto_children; GHashTable *auto_child_hash; auto_children = (GHashTable *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children); if (auto_children == NULL) { if (!create) return NULL; auto_children = g_hash_table_new_full (g_direct_hash, NULL, NULL, (GDestroyNotify)g_hash_table_destroy); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children, auto_children, (GDestroyNotify)g_hash_table_destroy); } auto_child_hash = g_hash_table_lookup (auto_children, GSIZE_TO_POINTER (type)); if (!auto_child_hash && create) { auto_child_hash = g_hash_table_new_full (g_str_hash, g_str_equal, NULL, (GDestroyNotify)g_object_unref); g_hash_table_insert (auto_children, GSIZE_TO_POINTER (type), auto_child_hash); } return auto_child_hash; } static gboolean setup_template_child (GtkWidgetTemplate *template_data, GType class_type, AutomaticChildClass *child_class, GtkWidget *widget, GtkBuilder *builder) { GHashTable *auto_child_hash; GObject *object; object = gtk_builder_get_object (builder, child_class->name); if (!object) { g_critical ("Unable to retrieve object '%s' from class template for type '%s' while building a '%s'", child_class->name, g_type_name (class_type), G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); return FALSE; } /* Insert into the hash so that it can be fetched with * gtk_widget_get_template_child() and also in automated * implementations of GtkBuildable.get_internal_child() */ auto_child_hash = get_auto_child_hash (widget, class_type, TRUE); g_hash_table_insert (auto_child_hash, child_class->name, g_object_ref (object)); if (child_class->offset != 0) { gpointer field_p; /* Assign 'object' to the specified offset in the instance (or private) data */ field_p = G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (widget, child_class->offset); (* (gpointer *) field_p) = object; } return TRUE; } /** * gtk_widget_init_template: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Creates and initializes child widgets defined in templates. This * function must be called in the instance initializer for any * class which assigned itself a template using gtk_widget_class_set_template() * * It is important to call this function in the instance initializer * of a #GtkWidget subclass and not in #GObject.constructed() or * #GObject.constructor() for two reasons. * * One reason is that generally derived widgets will assume that parent * class composite widgets have been created in their instance * initializers. * * Another reason is that when calling g_object_new() on a widget with * composite templates, it’s important to build the composite widgets * before the construct properties are set. Properties passed to g_object_new() * should take precedence over properties set in the private template XML. * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_init_template (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetTemplate *template; GtkBuilder *builder; GError *error = NULL; GObject *object; GSList *l; GType class_type; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); object = G_OBJECT (widget); class_type = G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget); template = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->priv->template; g_return_if_fail (template != NULL); builder = gtk_builder_new (); /* Add any callback symbols declared for this GType to the GtkBuilder namespace */ for (l = template->callbacks; l; l = l->next) { CallbackSymbol *callback = l->data; gtk_builder_add_callback_symbol (builder, callback->callback_name, callback->callback_symbol); } /* This will build the template XML as children to the widget instance, also it * will validate that the template is created for the correct GType and assert that * there is no infinite recursion. */ if (!gtk_builder_extend_with_template (builder, widget, class_type, (const gchar *)g_bytes_get_data (template->data, NULL), g_bytes_get_size (template->data), &error)) { g_critical ("Error building template class '%s' for an instance of type '%s': %s", g_type_name (class_type), G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (object), error->message); g_error_free (error); /* This should never happen, if the template XML cannot be built * then it is a critical programming error. */ g_object_unref (builder); return; } /* Build the automatic child data */ for (l = template->children; l; l = l->next) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; /* This will setup the pointer of an automated child, and cause * it to be available in any GtkBuildable.get_internal_child() * invocations which may follow by reference in child classes. */ if (!setup_template_child (template, class_type, child_class, widget, builder)) { g_object_unref (builder); return; } } /* Connect signals. All signal data from a template receive the * template instance as user data automatically. * * A GtkBuilderConnectFunc can be provided to gtk_widget_class_set_signal_connect_func() * in order for templates to be usable by bindings. */ if (template->connect_func) gtk_builder_connect_signals_full (builder, template->connect_func, template->connect_data); else gtk_builder_connect_signals (builder, object); g_object_unref (builder); } /** * gtk_widget_class_set_template: * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass * @template_bytes: A #GBytes holding the #GtkBuilder XML * * This should be called at class initialization time to specify * the GtkBuilder XML to be used to extend a widget. * * For convenience, gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource() is also provided. * * Note that any class that installs templates must call gtk_widget_init_template() * in the widget’s instance initializer. * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_class_set_template (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, GBytes *template_bytes) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template == NULL); g_return_if_fail (template_bytes != NULL); widget_class->priv->template = g_slice_new0 (GtkWidgetTemplate); widget_class->priv->template->data = g_bytes_ref (template_bytes); } /** * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource: * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass * @resource_name: The name of the resource to load the template from * * A convenience function to call gtk_widget_class_set_template(). * * Note that any class that installs templates must call gtk_widget_init_template() * in the widget’s instance initializer. * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, const gchar *resource_name) { GError *error = NULL; GBytes *bytes = NULL; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template == NULL); g_return_if_fail (resource_name && resource_name[0]); /* This is a hack, because class initializers now access resources * and GIR/gtk-doc initializes classes without initializing GTK+, * we ensure that our base resources are registered here and * avoid warnings which building GIRs/documentation. */ _gtk_ensure_resources (); bytes = g_resources_lookup_data (resource_name, 0, &error); if (!bytes) { g_critical ("Unable to load resource for composite template for type '%s': %s", G_OBJECT_CLASS_NAME (widget_class), error->message); g_error_free (error); return; } gtk_widget_class_set_template (widget_class, bytes); g_bytes_unref (bytes); } /** * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback_full: * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass * @callback_name: The name of the callback as expected in the template XML * @callback_symbol: (scope async): The callback symbol * * Declares a @callback_symbol to handle @callback_name from the template XML * defined for @widget_type. See gtk_builder_add_callback_symbol(). * * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback_full (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, const gchar *callback_name, GCallback callback_symbol) { CallbackSymbol *cb; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); g_return_if_fail (callback_name && callback_name[0]); g_return_if_fail (callback_symbol != NULL); cb = callback_symbol_new (callback_name, callback_symbol); widget_class->priv->template->callbacks = g_slist_prepend (widget_class->priv->template->callbacks, cb); } /** * gtk_widget_class_set_connect_func: * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass * @connect_func: The #GtkBuilderConnectFunc to use when connecting signals in the class template * @connect_data: The data to pass to @connect_func * @connect_data_destroy: The #GDestroyNotify to free @connect_data, this will only be used at * class finalization time, when no classes of type @widget_type are in use anymore. * * For use in language bindings, this will override the default #GtkBuilderConnectFunc to be * used when parsing GtkBuilder XML from this class’s template data. * * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_class_set_connect_func (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, GtkBuilderConnectFunc connect_func, gpointer connect_data, GDestroyNotify connect_data_destroy) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); /* Defensive, destroy any previously set data */ if (widget_class->priv->template->connect_data && widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify) widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify (widget_class->priv->template->connect_data); widget_class->priv->template->connect_func = connect_func; widget_class->priv->template->connect_data = connect_data; widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify = connect_data_destroy; } /** * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full: * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass * @name: The “id” of the child defined in the template XML * @internal_child: Whether the child should be accessible as an “internal-child” * when this class is used in GtkBuilder XML * @struct_offset: The structure offset into the composite widget’s instance public or private structure * where the automated child pointer should be set, or 0 to not assign the pointer. * * Automatically assign an object declared in the class template XML to be set to a location * on a freshly built instance’s private data, or alternatively accessible via gtk_widget_get_template_child(). * * The struct can point either into the public instance, then you should use G_STRUCT_OFFSET(WidgetType, member) * for @struct_offset, or in the private struct, then you should use G_PRIVATE_OFFSET(WidgetType, member). * * An explicit strong reference will be held automatically for the duration of your * instance’s life cycle, it will be released automatically when #GObjectClass.dispose() runs * on your instance and if a @struct_offset that is != 0 is specified, then the automatic location * in your instance public or private data will be set to %NULL. You can however access an automated child * pointer the first time your classes #GObjectClass.dispose() runs, or alternatively in * #GtkWidgetClass.destroy(). * * If @internal_child is specified, #GtkBuildableIface.get_internal_child() will be automatically * implemented by the #GtkWidget class so there is no need to implement it manually. * * The wrapper macros gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child(), gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_internal(), * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private() and gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_internal_private() * might be more convenient to use. * * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). * * Since: 3.10 */ void gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, const gchar *name, gboolean internal_child, gssize struct_offset) { AutomaticChildClass *child_class; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); g_return_if_fail (name && name[0]); child_class = template_child_class_new (name, internal_child, struct_offset); widget_class->priv->template->children = g_slist_prepend (widget_class->priv->template->children, child_class); } /** * gtk_widget_get_template_child: * @widget: A #GtkWidget * @widget_type: The #GType to get a template child for * @name: The “id” of the child defined in the template XML * * Fetch an object build from the template XML for @widget_type in this @widget instance. * * This will only report children which were previously declared with * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full() or one of its * variants. * * This function is only meant to be called for code which is private to the @widget_type which * declared the child and is meant for language bindings which cannot easily make use * of the GObject structure offsets. * * Returns: (transfer none): The object built in the template XML with the id @name */ GObject * gtk_widget_get_template_child (GtkWidget *widget, GType widget_type, const gchar *name) { GHashTable *auto_child_hash; GObject *ret = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_name (widget_type) != NULL, NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (name && name[0], NULL); auto_child_hash = get_auto_child_hash (widget, widget_type, FALSE); if (auto_child_hash) ret = g_hash_table_lookup (auto_child_hash, name); return ret; } /** * gtk_widget_list_action_prefixes: * @widget: A #GtkWidget * * Retrieves a %NULL-terminated array of strings containing the prefixes of * #GActionGroup's available to @widget. * * Returns: (transfer container): a %NULL-terminated array of strings. * * Since: 3.16 */ const gchar ** gtk_widget_list_action_prefixes (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkActionMuxer *muxer; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, FALSE); if (muxer) return gtk_action_muxer_list_prefixes (muxer); return g_new0 (const gchar *, 1); } /** * gtk_widget_get_action_group: * @widget: A #GtkWidget * @prefix: The “prefix” of the action group. * * Retrieves the #GActionGroup that was registered using @prefix. The resulting * #GActionGroup may have been registered to @widget or any #GtkWidget in its * ancestry. * * If no action group was found matching @prefix, then %NULL is returned. * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): A #GActionGroup or %NULL. * * Since: 3.16 */ GActionGroup * gtk_widget_get_action_group (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *prefix) { GtkActionMuxer *muxer; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (prefix, NULL); muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, FALSE); if (muxer) return gtk_action_muxer_lookup (muxer, prefix); return NULL; } static void event_controller_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean was_grabbed, EventControllerData *data) { GdkDevice *device = NULL; if (GTK_IS_GESTURE (data->controller)) device = gtk_gesture_get_device (GTK_GESTURE (data->controller)); if (!device || !gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (widget, device)) return; gtk_event_controller_reset (data->controller); } static void event_controller_sequence_state_changed (GtkGesture *gesture, GdkEventSequence *sequence, GtkEventSequenceState state, GtkWidget *widget) { gboolean handled = FALSE; GtkWidget *event_widget; const GdkEvent *event; handled = _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (widget, sequence, state, gesture); if (!handled || state != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) return; event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, sequence); if (!event) return; event_widget = gtk_get_event_target ((GdkEvent *) event); cancel_event_sequence_on_hierarchy (widget, event_widget, sequence); } static EventControllerData * _gtk_widget_has_controller (GtkWidget *widget, GtkEventController *controller) { EventControllerData *data; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GList *l; priv = widget->priv; for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { data = l->data; if (data->controller == controller) return data; } return NULL; } void _gtk_widget_add_controller (GtkWidget *widget, GtkEventController *controller) { EventControllerData *data; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_EVENT_CONTROLLER (controller)); g_return_if_fail (widget == gtk_event_controller_get_widget (controller)); priv = widget->priv; data = _gtk_widget_has_controller (widget, controller); if (data) return; data = g_new0 (EventControllerData, 1); data->controller = controller; data->grab_notify_id = g_signal_connect (widget, "grab-notify", G_CALLBACK (event_controller_grab_notify), data); g_object_add_weak_pointer (G_OBJECT (data->controller), (gpointer *) &data->controller); if (GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) { data->sequence_state_changed_id = g_signal_connect (controller, "sequence-state-changed", G_CALLBACK (event_controller_sequence_state_changed), widget); } priv->event_controllers = g_list_prepend (priv->event_controllers, data); } void _gtk_widget_remove_controller (GtkWidget *widget, GtkEventController *controller) { EventControllerData *data; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_EVENT_CONTROLLER (controller)); data = _gtk_widget_has_controller (widget, controller); if (!data) return; g_object_remove_weak_pointer (G_OBJECT (data->controller), (gpointer *) &data->controller); if (g_signal_handler_is_connected (widget, data->grab_notify_id)) g_signal_handler_disconnect (widget, data->grab_notify_id); if (data->sequence_state_changed_id) g_signal_handler_disconnect (data->controller, data->sequence_state_changed_id); data->controller = NULL; } GList * _gtk_widget_list_controllers (GtkWidget *widget, GtkPropagationPhase phase) { EventControllerData *data; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GList *l, *retval = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { data = l->data; if (data->controller != NULL && phase == gtk_event_controller_get_propagation_phase (data->controller)) retval = g_list_prepend (retval, data->controller); } return retval; } gboolean _gtk_widget_consumes_motion (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventSequence *sequence) { EventControllerData *data; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GList *l; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); priv = widget->priv; for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { data = l->data; if (data->controller == NULL) continue; if ((!GTK_IS_GESTURE_SINGLE (data->controller) || GTK_IS_GESTURE_DRAG (data->controller) || GTK_IS_GESTURE_SWIPE (data->controller)) && gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (GTK_GESTURE (data->controller), sequence)) return TRUE; } return FALSE; } void gtk_widget_reset_controllers (GtkWidget *widget) { EventControllerData *controller_data; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *l; /* Reset all controllers */ for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) { controller_data = l->data; gtk_event_controller_reset (controller_data->controller); } } static inline void gtk_widget_maybe_add_debug_render_nodes (GtkWidget *widget, GtkSnapshot *snapshot) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GdkDisplay *display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); GtkCssStyle *style; GtkBorder margin, border, padding; /* We should be offset to priv->allocation at this point */ if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, LAYOUT)) { graphene_rect_t bounds; GdkRGBA widget_margin_color = {0.7, 0, 0, 0.6}; GdkRGBA margin_color = {0.7, 0.7, 0, 0.6}; GdkRGBA padding_color = {0.7, 0, 0.7, 0.6}; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); /* Widget margins */ graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, -priv->margin.top, priv->allocation.width, priv->margin.top); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &widget_margin_color, &bounds, "Widget margin top"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, priv->allocation.height, priv->allocation.width, priv->margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &widget_margin_color, &bounds, "Widget margin bottom"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, -priv->margin.left, 0, priv->margin.left, priv->allocation.height); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &widget_margin_color, &bounds, "Widget margin left"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, priv->allocation.width, 0, priv->margin.right, priv->allocation.height); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &widget_margin_color, &bounds, "Widget margin right"); /* CSS Margins */ graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, 0, priv->allocation.width, margin.top); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &margin_color, &bounds, "Margin top"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, priv->allocation.height - margin.bottom, priv->allocation.width, margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &margin_color, &bounds, "Margin bottom"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, margin.top, margin.left, priv->allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &margin_color, &bounds, "Margin left"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, priv->allocation.width - margin.right, margin.top, margin.right, priv->allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &margin_color, &bounds, "Margin right"); /* Padding */ graphene_rect_init (&bounds, margin.left + border.left, margin.top + border.top, priv->allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right - border.left - border.right, padding.top); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &padding_color, &bounds, "Padding top"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, margin.left + border.left, priv->allocation.height - margin.bottom - border.bottom - padding.bottom, priv->allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right - border.left - border.right, padding.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &padding_color, &bounds, "Padding bottom"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, margin.left + border.left, margin.top + border.top + padding.top, padding.left, priv->allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom - border.top - border.bottom - padding.top - padding.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &padding_color, &bounds, "Padding left"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, priv->allocation.width - margin.left - border.right - padding.right, margin.top + border.top + padding.top, padding.right, priv->allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom - border.top - border.bottom - padding.top - padding.bottom); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &padding_color, &bounds, "Padding right"); } if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, BASELINES)) { int baseline = gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline (widget); if (baseline != -1) { GdkRGBA red = {1, 0, 0, 1}; graphene_rect_t bounds; style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); /* Baselines are relative to the widget's origin, * and we are offset to the widget's allocation here */ graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, margin.top + border.top + padding.top + baseline, priv->allocation.width, 1); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &red, &bounds, "Baseline Debug"); } } #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, RESIZE) && priv->highlight_resize) { GdkRGBA blue = {0, 0, 1, 0.2}; graphene_rect_t bounds; graphene_rect_init (&bounds, 0, 0, priv->allocation.width, priv->allocation.height); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &blue, &bounds, "Baseline Debug"); priv->highlight_resize = FALSE; gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); } #endif if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, GEOMETRY)) { GdkRGBA clip_color = {0, 0, 1, 0.7}; GtkAllocation offset_clip; graphene_rect_t bounds; offset_clip = priv->clip; offset_clip.x -= priv->allocation.x; offset_clip.y -= priv->allocation.y; graphene_rect_init (&bounds, offset_clip.x, offset_clip.y, offset_clip.width, 1); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &clip_color, &bounds, "Clip Top"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, offset_clip.x, offset_clip.y + offset_clip.height - 1, offset_clip.width, 1); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &clip_color, &bounds, "Clip bottom"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, offset_clip.x, offset_clip.y + 1, 1, offset_clip.height - 2); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &clip_color, &bounds, "Clip left"); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, offset_clip.x + offset_clip.width - 1, offset_clip.y + 1, 1, offset_clip.height - 2); gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, &clip_color, &bounds, "Clip right"); } } void gtk_widget_snapshot (GtkWidget *widget, GtkSnapshot *snapshot) { GtkWidgetClass *klass = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; graphene_rect_t bounds; GtkCssValue *filter_value; RenderMode mode; double opacity; cairo_rectangle_int_t offset_clip; GtkCssStyle *style; GtkAllocation allocation; GtkBorder margin, border, padding; if (!_gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) return; if (_gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (widget)) { g_warning ("Trying to snapshot %s %p without a current allocation", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); return; } priv = widget->priv; offset_clip = priv->clip; offset_clip.x -= priv->allocation.x; offset_clip.y -= priv->allocation.y; if (gtk_snapshot_clips_rect (snapshot, &offset_clip)) return; opacity = widget->priv->alpha / 255.0; if (opacity <= 0.0) return; /* Compatibility mode: if the widget does not have a render node, we draw * using gtk_widget_draw() on a temporary node */ mode = get_render_mode (klass); if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (SNAPSHOT)) gtk_snapshot_push (snapshot, TRUE, "%s<%p>", gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); filter_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_property (_gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_FILTER); gtk_css_filter_value_push_snapshot (filter_value, snapshot); graphene_rect_init (&bounds, offset_clip.x, offset_clip.y, offset_clip.width, offset_clip.height); style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); _gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &allocation); if (mode == RENDER_DRAW) { cairo_t *cr; cr = gtk_snapshot_append_cairo (snapshot, &bounds, "Fallback<%s>", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr); cairo_destroy (cr); } else { if (opacity < 1.0) gtk_snapshot_push_opacity (snapshot, opacity, "Opacity<%s,%f>", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), opacity); if (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) { gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, margin.left, margin.top); gtk_css_style_snapshot_background (style, snapshot, allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right, allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom); gtk_css_style_snapshot_border (style, snapshot, allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right, allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, - margin.left, - margin.top); } /* Offset to content allocation */ gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, margin.left + padding.left + border.left, margin.top + border.top + padding.top); klass->snapshot (widget, snapshot); gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, - (margin.left + padding.left + border.left), -(margin.top + border.top + padding.top)); if (g_signal_has_handler_pending (widget, widget_signals[DRAW], 0, FALSE)) { /* Compatibility mode: if there's a ::draw signal handler, we add a * child node with the contents of the handler */ gboolean result; cairo_t *cr; cr = gtk_snapshot_append_cairo (snapshot, &bounds, "DrawSignalContents<%s>", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DRAW], 0, cr, &result); cairo_destroy (cr); } gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, margin.left, margin.top); gtk_css_style_snapshot_outline (style, snapshot, allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right, allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom); gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, - margin.left, - margin.top); if (opacity < 1.0) gtk_snapshot_pop (snapshot); } gtk_css_filter_value_pop_snapshot (filter_value, snapshot); #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG gtk_widget_maybe_add_debug_render_nodes (widget, snapshot); #endif if (GTK_DEBUG_CHECK (SNAPSHOT)) gtk_snapshot_pop (snapshot); } static gboolean should_record_names (GtkWidget *widget) { return gtk_inspector_is_recording (widget) || gsk_check_debug_flags (GSK_DEBUG_ANY); } void gtk_widget_render (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window, const cairo_region_t *region) { GdkDrawingContext *context; GtkSnapshot snapshot; GskRenderer *renderer; GskRenderNode *root; cairo_region_t *clip; /* We only render double buffered on native windows */ if (!gdk_window_has_native (window)) return; renderer = gtk_widget_get_renderer (widget); if (renderer == NULL) return; context = gsk_renderer_begin_draw_frame (renderer, region); clip = gdk_drawing_context_get_clip (context); gtk_snapshot_init (&snapshot, renderer, should_record_names (widget), clip, "Render<%s>", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); cairo_region_destroy (clip); gtk_widget_snapshot (widget, &snapshot); root = gtk_snapshot_finish (&snapshot); if (root != NULL) { gtk_inspector_record_render (widget, renderer, window, region, context, root); gsk_renderer_render (renderer, root, context); gsk_render_node_unref (root); } gsk_renderer_end_draw_frame (renderer, context); } /** * gtk_widget_get_first_child: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's first child * * Since: 3.90 */ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_first_child (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->first_child; } /** * gtk_widget_get_last_child: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's last child * * Since: 3.90 */ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_last_child (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->last_child; } /** * gtk_widget_get_next_sibling: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's next sibling * * Since: 3.90 */ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->next_sibling; } /** * gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's previous sibling * * Since: 3.90 */ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->prev_sibling; } /** * gtk_widget_insert_after: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @parent: the parent #GtkWidget to insert @widget into * @previous_sibling: (nullable): the new previous sibling of @widget or %NULL * * Inserts @widget into the child widget list of @parent. * It will be placed after @previous_sibling, or at the beginning if @previous_sibling is %NULL. * * After calling this function, gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling(widget) will return @previous_sibling. * * If @parent is already set as the parent widget of @widget, this function can also be used * to reorder @widget in the child widget list of @parent. * * Since: 3.92 */ void gtk_widget_insert_after (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *parent, GtkWidget *previous_sibling) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); g_return_if_fail (previous_sibling == NULL || GTK_IS_WIDGET (previous_sibling)); g_return_if_fail (previous_sibling == NULL || _gtk_widget_get_parent (previous_sibling) == parent); if (widget == previous_sibling || (previous_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (widget) == previous_sibling)) return; if (!previous_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_first_child (parent) == widget) return; gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, parent, previous_sibling); } /** * gtk_widget_insert_before: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @parent: the parent #GtkWidget to insert @widget into * @next_sibling: (nullable): the new next sibling of @widget or %NULL * * Inserts @widget into the child widget list of @parent. * It will be placed before @next_sibling, or at the end if @next_sibling is %NULL. * * After calling this function, gtk_widget_get_next_sibling(widget) will return @next_sibling. * * If @parent is already set as the parent widget of @widget, this function can also be used * to reorder @widget in the child widget list of @parent. * * Since: 3.92 */ void gtk_widget_insert_before (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *parent, GtkWidget *next_sibling) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); g_return_if_fail (next_sibling == NULL || GTK_IS_WIDGET (next_sibling)); g_return_if_fail (next_sibling == NULL || _gtk_widget_get_parent (next_sibling) == parent); if (widget == next_sibling || (next_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (widget) == next_sibling)) return; if (!next_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent) == widget) return; gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, parent, next_sibling ? _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (next_sibling) : _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent)); } void gtk_widget_forall (GtkWidget *widget, GtkCallback callback, gpointer user_data) { GtkWidget *child; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); child = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); while (child) { GtkWidget *next = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child); callback(child, user_data); child = next; } } /** * gtk_widget_snapshot_child: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @child: a child of @widget * @snapshot: #GtkSnapshot as passed to the widget. In particular, no * calls to gtk_snapshot_offset() should have been applied by the * parent. * * When a widget receives a call to the snapshot function, it must send * synthetic #GtkWidget::snapshot calls to all children. This function * provides a convenient way of doing this. A widget, when it receives * a call to its #GtkWidget::snapshot function, calls * gtk_widget_snapshot_child() once for each child, passing in * the @snapshot the widget received. * * gtk_widget_snapshot_child() takes care of translating the origin of * @snapshot, and deciding whether the child needs to be snapshot. It is a * convenient and optimized way of getting the same effect as calling * gtk_widget_snapshot() on the child directly. **/ void gtk_widget_snapshot_child (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *child, GtkSnapshot *snapshot) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (child); int x, y; g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_parent (child) == widget); g_return_if_fail (snapshot != NULL); x = priv->allocation.x; y = priv->allocation.y; gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, x, y); gtk_widget_snapshot (child, snapshot); gtk_snapshot_offset (snapshot, -x, -y); } void gtk_widget_set_focus_child (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *child) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (child != NULL) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (child)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_parent (child) == widget); } if (priv->focus_child) gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (priv->focus_child, GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED|GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUS_VISIBLE); if (child) { GtkWidget *toplevel; GtkStateFlags flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED; toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel) || gtk_window_get_focus_visible (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel))) flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUS_VISIBLE; gtk_widget_set_state_flags (child, flags, FALSE); } g_set_object (&priv->focus_child, child); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), child); /* TODO: ??? */ } GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_focus_child (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return priv->focus_child; } /** * gtk_widget_set_cursor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @cursor: (allow-none): the new cursor or %NULL to use the default * cursor * * Sets the cursor to be shown when pointer devices point towards @widget. * * If the @cursor is NULL, @widget will use the cursor inherited from the * parent widget. * * Since: 3.94 **/ void gtk_widget_set_cursor (GtkWidget *widget, GdkCursor *cursor) { GtkWidget *toplevel; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (cursor == NULL || GDK_IS_CURSOR (cursor)); if (!g_set_object (&widget->priv->cursor, cursor)) return; toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) gtk_window_maybe_update_cursor (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget, NULL); g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CURSOR]); } /** * gtk_widget_set_cursor_from_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @name: (allow-none): The name of the cursor or %NULL to use the default * cursor * * Sets a named cursor to be shown when pointer devices point towards @widget. * * This is a utility function that calls creates a cursor via * gdk_cursor_new_from_name() and then sets it on @widget with * gtk_widget_set_cursor(). See those 2 functions for details. * * On top of that, this function allows @name to be %NULL, which will * do the same as calling gtk_widget_set_cursor() with a %NULL cursor. * * Since: 3.94 **/ void gtk_widget_set_cursor_from_name (GtkWidget *widget, const char *name) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (name) { GdkCursor *cursor; cursor = gdk_cursor_new_from_name (name, NULL); gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, cursor); g_object_unref (cursor); } else { gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, NULL); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_cursor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Queries the cursor set via gtk_widget_set_cursor(). See that function for * details. * * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): the cursor curently in use or %NULL * to use the default. * * Since: 3.94 **/ GdkCursor * gtk_widget_get_cursor (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->cursor; } void gtk_widget_set_pass_through (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean pass_through) { widget->priv->pass_through = !!pass_through; } gboolean gtk_widget_get_pass_through (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->pass_through; } void gtk_widget_init_legacy_controller (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkEventController *controller; controller = _gtk_event_controller_legacy_new (widget); g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (widget), I_("gtk-widget-legacy-event-controller"), controller, g_object_unref); } /** * gtk_widget_get_width: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the content width of the widget, as passed to its size-allocate implementation. * This is the size you should be using in GtkWidgetClass.snapshot(). For pointer * events, see gtk_widget_contains(). * * Returns: The width of @widget * * Since: 3.94 */ int gtk_widget_get_width (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder margin, border, padding; GtkCssStyle *style; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); return priv->allocation.width - margin.left - margin.right - border.left - border.right - padding.left - padding.right; } /** * gtk_widget_get_height: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the content height of the widget, as passed to its size-allocate implementation. * This is the size you should be using in GtkWidgetClass.snapshot(). For pointer * events, see gtk_widget_contains(). * * Returns: The height of @widget * * Since: 3.94 */ int gtk_widget_get_height (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); GtkBorder margin, border, padding; GtkCssStyle *style; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); get_box_margin (style, &margin); get_box_border (style, &border); get_box_padding (style, &padding); return priv->allocation.height - margin.top - margin.bottom - border.top - border.bottom - padding.top - padding.bottom; }